3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
6 @include org-version.inc
8 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
9 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
10 @set txicodequoteundirected
11 @set txicodequotebacktick
13 @c Version and Contact Info
14 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
15 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
17 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
18 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
23 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
25 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
26 @c =======================================
28 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
29 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
33 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
35 @c orgkey{key} A key item
36 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
37 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
38 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
39 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
40 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
41 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
42 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
43 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
44 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
47 @c a key but no command
59 @c one key with a command
60 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
61 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
66 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
69 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
78 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
79 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
80 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
85 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
88 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
97 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
98 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
99 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
103 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
106 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
114 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
115 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
116 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
121 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
124 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
133 @c two keys with one command
134 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
135 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
141 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
144 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
150 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
154 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
156 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
157 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
158 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
165 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
169 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
180 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
181 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
182 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
188 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
191 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
197 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
201 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
202 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
203 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
209 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
212 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
218 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
222 @c two keys with two commands
223 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
224 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
225 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
232 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
233 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
236 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
237 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
247 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
250 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
253 @c Subheadings inside a table.
254 @macro tsubheading{text}
256 @subsubheading \text\
264 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
266 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
269 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
270 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
271 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
272 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
273 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
274 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
276 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
277 modify this GNU manual.''
281 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
283 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
287 @title The Org Manual
289 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
290 @author by Carsten Dominik
291 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
293 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
295 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
299 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
303 @c FIXME These hand-written next,prev,up node pointers make editing a lot
304 @c harder. There should be no need for them, makeinfo can do it
305 @c automatically for any document with a normal structure.
306 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
313 * Introduction:: Getting started
314 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
315 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
316 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
317 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
318 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
319 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
320 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
321 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
322 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
323 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
324 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
325 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
326 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
327 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
328 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
329 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
330 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
331 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
332 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
333 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
334 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
335 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
338 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
342 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
343 * Installation:: Installing Org
344 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
345 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
346 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
350 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
351 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
352 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
353 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
354 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
355 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
356 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
357 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
358 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
359 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
360 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
364 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
365 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
366 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
367 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
368 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
369 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
373 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
374 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
375 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
376 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
377 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
378 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
379 * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables
380 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
381 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
382 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
386 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
387 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
388 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
389 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
390 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
391 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
392 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
393 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
397 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
401 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
402 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
403 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
404 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
405 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
406 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
408 Extended use of TODO keywords
410 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
411 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
412 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
413 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
414 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
415 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
416 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
420 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
421 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
422 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
426 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
427 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
428 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
430 Properties and columns
432 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
433 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
434 * Property searches:: Matching property values
435 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
436 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
437 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
441 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
442 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
443 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
447 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
448 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
452 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
453 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
454 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
455 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
456 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
457 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
458 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
462 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
463 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
465 Deadlines and scheduling
467 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
468 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
472 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
473 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
474 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
476 Capture - Refile - Archive
478 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
479 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
480 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
481 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
482 * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another
483 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
487 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
488 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
489 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
493 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
494 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
495 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
499 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
500 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
504 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
505 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
506 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
507 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
508 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
509 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
510 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
511 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
513 The built-in agenda views
515 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
516 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
517 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
518 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
519 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
520 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
522 Presentation and sorting
524 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
525 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
526 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
530 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
531 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
532 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
534 Markup for rich export
536 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
537 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
538 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
539 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
540 * Index entries:: Making an index
541 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
542 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
544 Structural markup elements
546 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
547 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
548 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
549 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
551 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
552 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
553 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
554 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
555 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
559 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
560 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
561 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
562 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
563 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
567 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
568 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
569 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
570 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
571 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
572 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
573 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
574 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
575 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
576 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
577 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
578 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
582 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
583 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
595 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
611 OpenDocument Text export
613 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
614 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
615 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
616 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
617 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
618 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
619 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
620 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
621 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
622 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
623 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
625 Math formatting in ODT export
627 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
628 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
630 Advanced topics in ODT export
632 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
633 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
634 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
635 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
636 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
640 * Configuration:: Defining projects
641 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
642 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
643 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
647 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
648 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
649 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
650 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
651 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
652 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
653 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
654 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
658 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
659 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
661 Working with source code
663 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
664 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
665 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
666 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
667 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
668 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
669 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
670 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
671 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
672 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
673 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
674 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
678 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
679 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
681 Using header arguments
683 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
684 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
685 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
686 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
687 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
688 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
690 Specific header arguments
692 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
693 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
694 be collected and handled
695 * file:: Specify a path for file output
696 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
697 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
698 directory for code block execution
699 * exports:: Export code and/or results
700 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
701 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
702 files during tangling
703 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
705 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
707 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
708 expansion during tangling
709 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
710 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
711 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
712 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
713 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
714 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
715 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
716 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
717 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
718 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
719 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
720 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
724 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
725 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
726 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
727 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
728 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
729 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
730 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
731 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
732 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
733 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
734 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
736 Interaction with other packages
738 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
739 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
743 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
744 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
745 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
746 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
747 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
748 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
749 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
750 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
751 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
752 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
754 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
756 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
757 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
758 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
759 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
763 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
764 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
765 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
770 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
771 @chapter Introduction
775 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
776 * Installation:: Installing Org
777 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
778 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
779 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
782 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
786 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
787 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
789 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
790 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
791 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
792 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
793 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
794 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
795 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
796 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
797 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
798 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
799 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
800 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
801 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
804 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
805 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
806 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
808 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
809 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
810 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
812 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
813 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
814 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
815 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
816 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
817 the minor Orgstruct mode.
819 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
820 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
821 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
822 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
826 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
827 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
828 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
829 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
830 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
831 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
832 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
833 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
834 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
838 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
839 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
840 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
841 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
843 @cindex print edition
844 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
845 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
851 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
852 @section Installation
856 Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need
857 to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top
858 of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
861 @item By using Emacs package system.
862 @item By downloading Org as an archive.
863 @item By using Org's git repository.
866 We @b{strongly recommend} to stick to a single installation method.
868 @subsubheading Using Emacs packaging system
870 Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install
871 Elisp libraries. You can install Org with @kbd{M-x package-install RET org}.
872 To make sure your Org configuration is well taken into account, initialize
873 the package system with @code{(package-initialize)} before setting any Org
874 option. If you want to use Org's package repository, check out the
875 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}.
877 @subsubheading Downloading Org as an archive
879 You can download Org latest release from @uref{http://orgmode.org/, Org's
880 website}. In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your
884 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
887 The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included
888 in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @file{contrib} directory to your
892 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
895 Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system.
896 Run @code{make help} to list compilation and installation options.
898 @subsubheading Using Org's git repository
900 You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
904 $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git
908 Note that in this case, @code{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's
909 version in @file{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in
910 @file{org-loaddefs.el}.
912 Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above.
914 You can also compile with @code{make}, generate the documentation with
915 @code{make doc}, create a local configuration with @code{make config} and
916 install Org with @code{make install}. Please run @code{make help} to get
917 the list of compilation/installation options.
919 For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org
920 Build System page on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html,
923 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
928 @cindex global key bindings
929 @cindex key bindings, global
932 @findex org-store-link
935 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
936 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
940 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
943 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
944 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
945 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
947 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
948 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
950 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
951 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
952 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
953 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
956 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
957 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
958 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
959 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
962 @cindex Org mode, turning on
963 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
964 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
968 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
971 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
972 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
973 the file's name is. See also the variable
974 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
976 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
977 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
978 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
979 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
981 (transient-mark-mode 1)
983 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
984 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
985 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
987 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
994 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
995 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
996 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
997 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
998 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
999 moderators have to do.}.
1001 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1002 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1003 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1004 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1005 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1006 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1007 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1009 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1011 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1012 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1013 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1015 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1016 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1017 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1018 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1019 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1022 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1025 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1026 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1027 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1031 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1033 ;; activate debugging
1034 (setq debug-on-error t
1038 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1039 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1040 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1043 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1044 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1048 @item What exactly did you do?
1049 @item What did you expect to happen?
1050 @item What happened instead?
1052 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1054 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1056 @cindex backtrace of an error
1057 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1058 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1059 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1060 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1061 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1065 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1066 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1069 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1072 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1075 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1076 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1078 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1079 document the steps you take.
1081 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1082 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1083 attach it to your bug report.
1086 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1087 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1089 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1091 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1092 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1097 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1101 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1102 meaning are written with all capitals.
1105 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1106 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1109 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1110 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1111 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1112 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1113 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1116 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1122 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1123 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1124 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1126 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1127 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1128 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1129 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1130 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1131 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1132 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1133 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1134 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1135 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1137 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1138 @chapter Document structure
1139 @cindex document structure
1140 @cindex structure of document
1142 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1143 edit the structure of the document.
1146 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1147 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1148 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1149 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1150 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1151 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1152 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1153 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1154 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1155 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1156 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1159 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1162 @cindex Outline mode
1164 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1165 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1166 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1167 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1168 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1169 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1170 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1171 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1173 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1176 @cindex outline tree
1177 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1178 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1179 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1181 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1182 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1183 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1184 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1185 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1186 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1189 * Top level headline
1196 * Another top level headline
1199 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1200 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1201 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1203 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1204 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1205 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1206 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1207 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1208 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1210 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1211 @section Visibility cycling
1212 @cindex cycling, visibility
1213 @cindex visibility cycling
1214 @cindex trees, visibility
1215 @cindex show hidden text
1218 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1219 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1220 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1222 @cindex subtree visibility states
1223 @cindex subtree cycling
1224 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1225 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1226 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1228 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1229 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1232 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1233 '-----------------------------------'
1236 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1237 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1238 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1239 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1240 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1241 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1242 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1243 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1245 @cindex global visibility states
1246 @cindex global cycling
1247 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1248 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1249 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1250 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1251 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1252 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1255 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1256 '--------------------------------------'
1259 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1260 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1261 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1263 @cindex show all, command
1264 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1265 Show all, including drawers.
1266 @cindex revealing context
1267 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1268 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1269 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1270 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1271 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1272 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1273 entire subtree of the parent.
1274 @cindex show branches, command
1275 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1276 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1277 @cindex show children, command
1278 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1279 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1280 expose all children down to level N@.
1281 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1282 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1285 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1288 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1290 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1291 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1292 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1293 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1294 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1295 the previously used indirect buffer.
1296 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1297 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1300 @vindex org-startup-folded
1301 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1302 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1303 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1304 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1306 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1307 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1308 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1309 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1316 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1319 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1321 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1322 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1323 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1326 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1327 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1328 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1332 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1334 @cindex motion, between headlines
1335 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1336 @cindex headline navigation
1337 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1340 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1342 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1344 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1345 Next heading same level.
1346 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1347 Previous heading same level.
1348 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1349 Backward to higher level heading.
1350 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1351 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1352 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1353 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1354 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1356 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1357 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1358 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1359 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1360 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1361 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1362 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1364 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1367 @vindex org-goto-interface
1369 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1372 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1373 @section Structure editing
1374 @cindex structure editing
1375 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1376 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1377 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1378 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1379 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1380 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1381 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1382 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1383 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1386 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1387 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1388 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1389 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1390 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1391 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1392 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1393 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1394 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1395 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1396 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1397 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1398 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1399 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1400 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1401 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1402 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1403 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1404 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1405 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1406 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1407 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1408 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1409 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1411 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1412 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1413 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1414 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1415 to the initial level.
1416 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1417 Promote current heading by one level.
1418 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1419 Demote current heading by one level.
1420 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1421 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1422 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1423 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1424 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1425 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1427 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1428 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1429 @orgcmd{M-h,org-mark-element}
1430 Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements
1431 of the one just marked. E.g., hitting @key{M-h} on a paragraph will mark it,
1432 hitting @key{M-h} immediately again will mark the next one.
1433 @orgcmd{C-c @@,org-mark-subtree}
1434 Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees
1435 of the same level than the marked subtree.
1436 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1437 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1438 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1439 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1440 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1441 sequential subtrees.
1442 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1443 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1444 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1445 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1446 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1447 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1448 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1449 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1450 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1451 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1452 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1453 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1454 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1455 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1456 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1457 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1458 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1460 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1461 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1462 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1463 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1464 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1465 more details, see the docstring of the command
1466 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1467 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1468 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refile and copy}.
1469 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1470 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1471 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1472 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1473 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1474 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1475 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1476 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1477 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1478 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1479 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1480 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1481 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1482 Narrow buffer to current block.
1483 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1484 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1485 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1486 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1487 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1488 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1489 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1490 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1491 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1494 @cindex region, active
1495 @cindex active region
1496 @cindex transient mark mode
1497 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1498 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1499 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1500 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1501 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1502 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1506 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1507 @section Sparse trees
1508 @cindex sparse trees
1509 @cindex trees, sparse
1510 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1511 @cindex occur, command
1513 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1514 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1515 @vindex org-show-siblings
1516 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1517 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1518 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1519 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1520 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1521 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1522 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1523 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1524 and you will see immediately how it works.
1526 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1527 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1530 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1531 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1532 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1533 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1534 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1535 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1536 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1537 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1538 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1539 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1540 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1541 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1542 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1543 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1544 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1545 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1546 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1547 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1552 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1553 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1554 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1555 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1556 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1560 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1561 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1564 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1565 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1567 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1568 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1571 @cindex printing sparse trees
1572 @cindex visible text, printing
1573 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1574 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1575 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1576 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1577 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1578 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1580 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1581 @section Plain lists
1583 @cindex lists, plain
1584 @cindex lists, ordered
1585 @cindex ordered lists
1587 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1588 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1589 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1590 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1592 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1595 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1596 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1597 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1598 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1599 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1600 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1603 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1604 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1605 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1606 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1607 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1608 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1609 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1610 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1611 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1612 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1613 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1614 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1615 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1616 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1618 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1619 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1623 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1624 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1625 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1626 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1627 than its bullet/number.
1629 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1630 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1631 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1632 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1633 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1637 ** Lord of the Rings
1638 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1639 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1640 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1641 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1642 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1643 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1645 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1646 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1647 Important actors in this film are:
1648 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1649 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1650 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1654 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1655 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1656 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1657 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1658 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1659 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1660 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1662 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1663 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1664 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1665 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1666 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1667 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1668 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1670 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1671 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1672 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1673 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1674 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1675 to disable them individually.
1678 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1679 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1680 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1681 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1682 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1683 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1684 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1685 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1686 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1687 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1688 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1689 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1690 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1691 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1692 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1693 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1694 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1695 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1696 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1697 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1698 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1699 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1704 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1706 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1707 @kindex S-@key{down}
1710 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1711 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1712 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1713 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1714 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1715 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1716 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1717 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1720 @kindex M-@key{down}
1723 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1724 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1725 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1727 @kindex M-@key{left}
1728 @kindex M-@key{right}
1731 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1732 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1733 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1736 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1737 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1738 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1739 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1740 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1743 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1744 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1745 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1746 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1749 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1750 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1751 consistency in the whole list.
1753 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1755 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1756 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1757 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1758 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1759 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1760 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1761 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1762 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1763 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1766 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1767 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1770 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1771 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1773 @kindex S-@key{left}
1774 @kindex S-@key{right}
1776 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1777 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1778 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1779 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1782 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1783 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1786 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1790 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1793 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1795 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1796 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1797 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1798 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1799 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1803 ** This is a headline
1804 Still outside the drawer
1806 This is inside the drawer.
1811 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1812 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1813 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1814 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1815 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1816 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1818 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1819 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1820 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1821 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1822 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1823 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1824 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1825 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1830 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1833 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1836 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1837 @cindex blocks, folding
1838 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1839 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1840 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1841 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1842 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1843 or on a per-file basis by using
1845 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1846 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1848 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1849 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1852 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1856 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1857 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1858 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1859 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1860 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1861 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1862 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1863 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1866 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1868 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1871 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1872 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1873 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1874 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1875 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1879 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1880 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1883 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1884 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1885 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1886 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1888 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1889 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1890 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1891 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1894 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1895 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1896 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1897 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1900 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1905 The footnote action command.
1907 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1908 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1910 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1911 @vindex org-footnote-section
1912 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1913 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1914 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1915 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1916 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1917 separately into the location determined by the variable
1918 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1920 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1923 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1924 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1925 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1926 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1927 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1928 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1929 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1930 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1931 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1932 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1933 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1934 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1935 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1936 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1937 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1938 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1939 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1942 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1943 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1944 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1949 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1950 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1951 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1955 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1956 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1957 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1960 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1961 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1962 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1963 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1965 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1966 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1967 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1968 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1969 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1972 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1973 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1976 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1977 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1978 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1979 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1980 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1981 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1982 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1985 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1988 @cindex editing tables
1990 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1991 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1992 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1995 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1996 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1997 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1998 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1999 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2000 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2003 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2004 @section The built-in table editor
2005 @cindex table editor, built-in
2007 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2008 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2009 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2010 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2011 might look like this:
2014 | Name | Phone | Age |
2015 |-------+-------+-----|
2016 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2017 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2020 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2021 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2022 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2023 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2024 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2025 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2026 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2027 create the above table, you would only type
2034 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2035 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2036 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2038 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2039 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2040 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2041 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2042 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2043 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2044 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2045 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2046 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2047 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2050 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2051 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2052 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2053 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2054 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2055 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2056 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2057 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2058 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2060 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2061 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2062 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2064 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2065 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2066 Re-align the table and don't move to another field.
2068 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2069 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2072 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2073 Re-align, move to previous field.
2075 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2076 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2077 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2078 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2080 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2081 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2082 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2083 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2085 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2086 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2087 Move the current column left/right.
2089 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2090 Kill the current column.
2092 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2093 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2095 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2096 Move the current row up/down.
2098 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2099 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2101 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2102 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2103 created below the current one.
2105 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2106 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2107 is created above the current line.
2109 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2110 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2113 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2114 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2115 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2116 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2117 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2118 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2119 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2120 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2121 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2122 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2124 @tsubheading{Regions}
2125 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2126 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2127 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2128 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2130 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2131 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2132 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2134 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2135 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2136 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2137 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2138 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2141 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2142 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2143 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2144 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2145 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2146 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2147 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2150 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2151 @cindex formula, in tables
2152 @cindex calculations, in tables
2153 @cindex region, active
2154 @cindex active region
2155 @cindex transient mark mode
2156 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2157 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2158 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2159 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2161 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2162 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2163 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2164 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2165 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2166 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2167 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2168 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2169 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2171 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2172 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2173 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2174 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2175 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2176 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2177 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2178 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2179 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2181 @item M-x org-table-import
2182 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2183 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2184 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2185 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2186 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2187 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2189 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2190 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2191 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2192 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2194 @item M-x org-table-export
2195 @findex org-table-export
2196 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2197 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2198 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2199 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2200 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2201 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2202 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2203 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2204 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2205 detailed description.
2208 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2209 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2213 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2216 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2217 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2219 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2220 @section Column width and alignment
2221 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2222 @cindex alignment in tables
2224 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2225 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2226 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2228 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2229 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2230 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2231 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2232 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2233 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2234 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2238 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2240 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2241 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2242 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2243 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2244 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2249 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2250 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2251 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2252 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2253 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2254 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2257 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2258 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2259 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2260 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2261 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2262 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2263 on a per-file basis with:
2270 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2271 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2272 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2273 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2274 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<r10>}.
2276 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2277 automatically when exporting the document.
2279 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2280 @section Column groups
2281 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2283 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2284 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2285 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2286 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2287 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2288 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2289 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2290 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2291 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2292 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2293 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2296 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2297 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2298 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2299 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2300 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2301 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2302 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2303 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2306 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2307 every vertical line you would like to have:
2310 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2311 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2315 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2316 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2318 @cindex minor mode for tables
2320 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2321 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2322 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2323 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2324 example in Message mode, use
2327 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2330 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2331 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2332 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2333 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2334 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2336 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2337 @section The spreadsheet
2338 @cindex calculations, in tables
2339 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2340 @cindex @file{calc} package
2342 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2343 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2344 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2345 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2346 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2347 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2348 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2349 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2350 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2353 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2354 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2355 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2356 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2357 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2358 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2359 * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables
2360 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2361 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2362 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2365 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2366 @subsection References
2369 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2370 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2371 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2372 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2373 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2375 @subsubheading Field references
2376 @cindex field references
2377 @cindex references, to fields
2379 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2380 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2381 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2382 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2383 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2384 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2385 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2386 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2387 representation that looks like this:
2389 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2392 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2393 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2394 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2395 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2396 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2397 column from the right.
2399 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2400 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2401 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2402 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2403 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2404 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2405 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2406 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2407 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2408 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2409 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2410 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2411 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2412 after the third hline in the table.
2414 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2415 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2416 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2419 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2420 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2421 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2422 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2423 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2424 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2426 Here are a few examples:
2429 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2430 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2431 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2432 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2433 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2434 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2437 @subsubheading Range references
2438 @cindex range references
2439 @cindex references, to ranges
2441 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2442 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2443 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2444 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2445 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2446 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2449 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2450 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2451 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2452 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2453 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left}
2454 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2457 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2458 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2459 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2460 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2461 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2463 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2464 @cindex field coordinates
2465 @cindex coordinates, of field
2466 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2467 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2469 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2470 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2471 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2472 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2475 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2476 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2477 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2480 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2481 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2482 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2485 @subsubheading Named references
2486 @cindex named references
2487 @cindex references, named
2488 @cindex name, of column or field
2489 @cindex constants, in calculations
2492 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2493 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2494 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2495 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2499 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2503 @vindex constants-unit-system
2504 @pindex constants.el
2505 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2506 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2507 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2508 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2509 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2510 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2511 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2512 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2513 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2514 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2515 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2516 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2517 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2518 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2521 @subsubheading Remote references
2522 @cindex remote references
2523 @cindex references, remote
2524 @cindex references, to a different table
2525 @cindex name, of column or field
2526 @cindex constants, in calculations
2529 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2530 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2533 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2537 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2538 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2539 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2540 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2541 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2544 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2545 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2546 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2547 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2549 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2550 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2551 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2552 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2553 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2554 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2555 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2556 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2557 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2558 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2559 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2561 @cindex format specifier
2562 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2563 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2564 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2565 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2566 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2567 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2568 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2569 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2570 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2573 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2574 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2575 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2576 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2577 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2578 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2579 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2580 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges and use nan (not a number)}
2581 @r{in Calc formulas for empty fields in range references and}
2582 @r{for empty field references; else suppress empty fields in}
2583 @r{range references and use 0 for empty field references, see}
2584 @r{also the notes for `Range references' in @pxref{References}}
2585 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers;}
2586 @r{N has higher precedence than E (for the value of the field)}
2587 L @r{literal, for Lisp formulas only}
2591 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2592 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2593 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2594 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2595 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2596 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2597 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2598 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2599 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2603 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2604 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2605 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2606 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2607 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2608 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2609 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2610 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2611 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, suppress empty fields}
2612 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2613 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2616 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2619 if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))
2620 @r{"teen" if age $1 is less than 20, else empty}
2621 if("$1" = "nan" || "$2" = "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E
2622 @r{sum of first two columns unless one or both empty}
2625 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2626 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2628 You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with @code{defmath}
2629 and use them in formula syntax for Calc.
2631 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2632 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2633 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2635 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2636 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2639 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2640 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2641 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2642 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2644 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2645 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2646 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2647 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2648 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2649 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2650 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2651 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2652 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2653 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2655 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2656 computations in Lisp:
2659 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2660 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2661 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2663 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1--4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2664 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2667 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2668 @subsection Durations and time values
2669 @cindex Duration, computing
2670 @cindex Time, computing
2671 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2673 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2674 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2678 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2679 |---------+----------+----------|
2680 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2681 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2682 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2686 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2687 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2688 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2689 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2690 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2691 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2694 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2695 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2697 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2698 @subsection Field and range formulas
2699 @cindex field formula
2700 @cindex range formula
2701 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2702 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2704 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2705 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2706 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2707 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2708 current field will be replaced with the result.
2711 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2712 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2713 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2714 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2715 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2716 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2717 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2718 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2719 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2720 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2721 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2723 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2727 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2728 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2729 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2730 it to the current field, and stores it.
2733 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2734 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2735 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2736 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2741 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2742 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2744 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2747 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2748 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2750 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2753 @node Column formulas, Lookup functions, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2754 @subsection Column formulas
2755 @cindex column formula
2756 @cindex formula, for table column
2758 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2759 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2760 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2761 hlines with rows above and below, everything before the first such hline is
2762 considered part of the table @emph{header} and will not be modified by column
2763 formulas. Therefore a header is mandatory when you use column formulas and
2764 want to add hlines to group rows, like for example to separate a total row at
2765 the bottom from the summand rows above. (ii) Fields that already get a value
2766 from a field/range formula will be left alone by column formulas. These
2767 conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2769 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2770 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2771 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2772 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2773 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2774 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2775 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2776 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2777 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2778 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2780 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2784 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2785 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2786 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2787 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2788 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2789 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2792 @node Lookup functions, Editing and debugging formulas, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2793 @subsection Lookup functions
2794 @cindex lookup functions in tables
2795 @cindex table lookup functions
2797 Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables.
2799 @item (org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2800 @findex org-lookup-first
2801 Searches for the first element @code{S} in list @code{S-LIST} for which
2805 is @code{t}; returns the value from the corresponding position in list
2806 @code{R-LIST}. The default @code{PREDICATE} is @code{equal}. Note that the
2807 parameters @code{VAL} and @code{S} are passed to @code{PREDICATE} in the same
2808 order as the correspoding parameters are in the call to
2809 @code{org-lookup-first}, where @code{VAL} precedes @code{S-LIST}. If
2810 @code{R-LIST} is @code{nil}, the matching element @code{S} of @code{S-LIST}
2812 @item (org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2813 @findex org-lookup-last
2814 Similar to @code{org-lookup-first} above, but searches for the @i{last}
2815 element for which @code{PREDICATE} is @code{t}.
2816 @item (org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2817 @findex org-lookup-all
2818 Similar to @code{org-lookup-first}, but searches for @i{all} elements for
2819 which @code{PREDICATE} is @code{t}, and returns @i{all} corresponding
2820 values. This function can not be used by itself in a formula, because it
2821 returns a list of values. However, powerful lookups can be built when this
2822 function is combined with other Emacs Lisp functions.
2825 If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the @code{E} mode
2826 for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty fields will not be
2827 included in @code{S-LIST} and/or @code{R-LIST} which can, for example, result
2828 in an incorrect mapping from an element of @code{S-LIST} to the corresponding
2829 element of @code{R-LIST}.
2831 These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays, count
2832 matching cells, rank results, group data etc. For practical examples
2833 see @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html, this
2836 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Lookup functions, The spreadsheet
2837 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2838 @cindex formula editing
2839 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2841 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2842 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2843 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2844 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2845 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2846 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2847 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2848 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2851 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2852 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2853 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2854 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2855 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2856 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2857 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2858 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2859 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2860 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2861 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2863 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2865 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2866 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2867 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2869 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2871 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2872 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2873 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2874 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2875 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2876 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2877 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2878 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2879 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2881 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2882 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2883 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2884 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2885 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2886 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2887 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2888 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2889 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2890 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2891 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2892 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2893 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2894 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2895 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2897 @kindex S-@key{down}
2898 @kindex S-@key{left}
2899 @kindex S-@key{right}
2900 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2901 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2902 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2903 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2904 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2905 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2906 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2907 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2908 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2909 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2911 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2912 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2914 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2916 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2920 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2921 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2922 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2923 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2924 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2927 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2928 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2929 recalculation commands in the table.
2931 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2932 @cindex formula debugging
2933 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2934 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2935 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2936 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2937 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2938 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2939 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2941 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2942 @subsection Updating the table
2943 @cindex recomputing table fields
2944 @cindex updating, table
2946 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2947 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2948 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2950 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2954 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2955 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2956 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2962 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2963 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2965 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2966 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2967 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2968 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2969 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2970 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2971 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2972 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2973 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2974 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2978 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2979 @subsection Advanced features
2981 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2982 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2983 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2984 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2985 special marking characters.
2988 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2989 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2990 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2991 change all marks in the region.
2994 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2995 makes use of these features:
2999 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3000 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
3001 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3002 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
3003 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
3004 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
3005 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3006 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
3007 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
3008 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3009 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
3010 | ^ | | | | | at | |
3011 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
3012 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3013 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
3017 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
3018 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
3019 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3020 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3023 @cindex marking characters, tables
3024 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3027 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3028 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3030 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3031 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3032 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3033 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3035 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3038 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3039 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3040 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3041 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3044 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3045 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3046 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3047 lines will be left alone by this command.
3049 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3050 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3051 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3053 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3054 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3057 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3058 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3061 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3062 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3063 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3068 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3069 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3070 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3071 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3072 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3073 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3074 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3075 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3076 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3077 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3078 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3082 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3084 @cindex graph, in tables
3085 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3088 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3089 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3090 @uref{http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode}. To see this in action, ensure
3091 that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then
3092 call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3096 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3097 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3098 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3099 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3100 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3101 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3102 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3103 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3107 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3108 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3109 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3110 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3111 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3112 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3114 @subsubheading Plot Options
3118 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3121 Specify the title of the plot.
3124 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3127 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3128 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3129 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3133 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3136 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3137 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3138 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3141 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3144 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3148 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3151 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3152 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3155 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3156 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3159 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3160 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3161 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3162 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3163 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3167 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3171 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3172 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3175 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3176 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3177 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3178 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3179 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3180 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3181 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3182 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3185 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3186 @section Link format
3188 @cindex format, of links
3190 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3191 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3194 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3198 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3199 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3200 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3201 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3202 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3203 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3204 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3205 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3208 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3209 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3210 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3211 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3212 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3213 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3214 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3216 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3217 @section Internal links
3218 @cindex internal links
3219 @cindex links, internal
3220 @cindex targets, for links
3222 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3223 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3224 current file. The most important case is a link like
3225 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3226 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3227 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3228 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3231 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3232 lead to a text search in the current file.
3234 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3235 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3236 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3237 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3238 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3239 comment line. For example
3245 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3246 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3247 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3248 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3251 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3252 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3253 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3254 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3255 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3256 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3257 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3259 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3260 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3261 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3265 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3268 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3269 @subsection Radio targets
3270 @cindex radio targets
3271 @cindex targets, radio
3272 @cindex links, radio targets
3274 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3275 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3276 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3277 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3278 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3279 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3280 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3281 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3282 cursor on or at a target.
3284 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3285 @section External links
3286 @cindex links, external
3287 @cindex external links
3288 @cindex links, external
3296 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3298 @cindex USENET links
3303 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3304 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3305 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3306 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3307 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3310 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3311 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3312 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3313 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3314 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3315 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3316 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3317 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3318 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3319 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3320 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3321 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3322 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3323 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3324 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3325 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3326 will be queried to create it.}
3327 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3328 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3329 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3330 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3331 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3332 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3333 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3334 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3335 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3336 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3337 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3338 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3339 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3340 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3341 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3342 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3343 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3344 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3345 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3346 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3347 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3348 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3349 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3350 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3351 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3352 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3355 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3357 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3358 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3359 format}), for example:
3362 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3366 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3367 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3368 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3370 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3372 @cindex square brackets, around links
3373 @cindex plain text external links
3374 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3375 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3376 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3377 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3379 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3380 @section Handling links
3381 @cindex links, handling
3383 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3384 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3387 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3388 @cindex storing links
3389 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3390 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3391 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3392 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3395 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3396 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3397 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3398 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3399 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3400 timestamp in the headline.}.
3402 @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id
3403 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3404 @cindex property, ID
3405 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3406 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3407 @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will
3408 be created and/or used to construct a link@footnote{The library @code{org-id}
3409 must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize} by enabling
3410 @code{id} in @code{org-modules} , or by adding @code{(require 'org-id)} in
3411 your @file{.emacs}.}. So using this command in Org
3412 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3413 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3414 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3417 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3418 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3419 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3420 constructed from the author and the subject.
3422 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3423 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3425 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3426 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3429 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3430 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3431 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3432 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3433 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3436 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3437 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3438 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3439 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3440 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3441 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3442 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3445 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3446 entry referenced by the current line.
3449 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3450 @cindex link completion
3451 @cindex completion, of links
3452 @cindex inserting links
3453 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3454 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3455 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3456 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3457 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3458 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3459 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3460 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3461 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3462 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3463 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3464 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3465 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3466 becomes the default description.
3468 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3469 All links stored during the
3470 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3471 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3473 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3474 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3475 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3476 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3477 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3478 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3479 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3480 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3481 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3483 @cindex file name completion
3484 @cindex completion, of file names
3485 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3486 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3487 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3488 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3489 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3490 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3491 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3492 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3494 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3495 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3496 link and description parts of the link.
3498 @cindex following links
3499 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3500 @vindex org-file-apps
3501 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3502 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3503 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3504 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3505 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3506 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3507 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3508 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3509 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3510 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3511 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3512 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3513 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3514 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3515 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3516 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3519 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3520 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3527 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3528 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3532 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3533 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3534 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3535 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3537 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3538 @cindex inlining images
3539 @cindex images, inlining
3540 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3541 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3542 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3543 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3544 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3545 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3546 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3547 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3548 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3549 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3550 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3552 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3553 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3555 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3556 @cindex links, returning to
3557 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3558 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3559 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3560 previously recorded positions.
3562 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3563 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3564 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3565 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3566 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3567 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3569 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3571 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3572 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3576 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3577 @section Using links outside Org
3579 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3580 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3581 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3585 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3586 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3589 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3590 @section Link abbreviations
3591 @cindex link abbreviations
3592 @cindex abbreviation, links
3594 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3595 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3596 abbreviated link looks like this
3599 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3603 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3604 where the tag is optional.
3605 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3606 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3607 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3608 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3612 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3613 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3614 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3615 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3616 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3617 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3618 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3622 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3623 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3624 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3625 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3626 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3628 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3629 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3631 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3632 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3634 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3635 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3636 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3637 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3638 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3639 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3640 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3642 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3643 can define them in the file with
3647 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3648 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3652 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3653 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3654 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3655 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3656 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3658 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3659 @section Search options in file links
3660 @cindex search option in file links
3661 @cindex file links, searching
3663 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3664 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3665 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3666 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3667 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3668 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3669 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3670 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3672 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3673 link, together with an explanation:
3676 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3677 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3678 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3679 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3680 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3687 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3688 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3689 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3690 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3693 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3695 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3697 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3698 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3699 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3700 sparse tree with the matches.
3701 @c If the target file is a directory,
3702 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3705 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3706 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3707 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3708 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3710 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3711 @section Custom Searches
3712 @cindex custom search strings
3713 @cindex search strings, custom
3715 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3716 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3717 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3718 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3719 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3722 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3723 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3724 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3725 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3726 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3727 to be added to the hook variables
3728 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3729 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3730 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3731 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3732 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3734 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3738 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3739 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3740 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3741 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3742 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3743 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3744 item emerged is always present.
3746 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3747 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3748 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3751 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3752 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3753 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3754 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3755 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3756 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3759 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3760 @section Basic TODO functionality
3762 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3763 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3766 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3770 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3773 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3774 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3775 @vindex org-use-fast-todo-selection
3777 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3780 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3781 '--------------------------------'
3784 If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO
3785 states}), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection
3786 interface; this is the default behavior when
3787 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is @code{non-nil}.
3789 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and agenda
3790 buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3792 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3793 When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using
3794 completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When
3795 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is set to @code{prefix}, use the fast
3796 selection interface.
3798 @kindex S-@key{right}
3799 @kindex S-@key{left}
3800 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3801 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3802 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3803 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3804 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3805 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3806 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3807 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3808 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3809 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3810 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3811 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3812 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3813 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3814 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3815 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3816 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3817 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3818 both un-done and done.
3819 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3820 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3821 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3822 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3823 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3824 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3825 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3826 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3830 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3831 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3832 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3834 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3835 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3836 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3838 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3839 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3840 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3841 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3842 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3845 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3846 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3849 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3850 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3851 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3852 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3853 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3854 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3855 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3858 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3859 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3860 @cindex TODO workflow
3861 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3863 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3864 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3865 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3869 (setq org-todo-keywords
3870 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3873 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3874 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3875 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3877 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3878 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3879 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3880 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3881 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3882 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3883 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3884 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3885 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3886 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3887 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3889 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3890 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3892 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3893 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3895 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3896 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3897 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3898 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3899 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3900 be set up like this:
3903 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3906 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3907 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3908 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3909 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3910 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3911 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3912 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3913 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3914 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3915 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3916 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3917 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3918 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3919 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3921 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3922 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3923 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3925 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3926 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3927 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3928 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3929 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3933 (setq org-todo-keywords
3934 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3935 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3936 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3939 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3940 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3941 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3942 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3943 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3944 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3945 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3948 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3949 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3950 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3951 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3952 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3953 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3954 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3955 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3956 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3957 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3958 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3959 @kindex S-@key{right}
3960 @kindex S-@key{left}
3963 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3964 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3965 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3966 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3967 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3970 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3971 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3973 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3974 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3975 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3976 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3977 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3980 (setq org-todo-keywords
3981 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3982 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3983 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3986 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3987 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3988 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3989 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3990 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3991 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3992 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3993 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3995 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3996 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3997 @cindex keyword options
3998 @cindex per-file keywords
4003 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
4004 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
4005 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
4006 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
4007 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
4011 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
4013 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
4014 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
4016 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
4019 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
4023 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
4027 @cindex completion, of option keywords
4029 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4030 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4032 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4033 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4034 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4035 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4036 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4037 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4038 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4039 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4040 for the current buffer.}.
4042 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4043 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4044 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4046 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4047 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4048 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4049 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4050 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4051 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4052 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4053 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
4054 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4058 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4059 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4060 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4064 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4065 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4066 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4067 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4068 foreground or a background color.
4070 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4071 @subsection TODO dependencies
4072 @cindex TODO dependencies
4073 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4075 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4076 @cindex property, ORDERED
4077 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4078 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4079 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4080 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4081 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4082 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4083 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4084 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4085 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4089 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4098 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4099 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4103 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4104 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4105 @cindex property, ORDERED
4106 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4107 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4108 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4109 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4110 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4111 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4112 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4115 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4116 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4117 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4118 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4120 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4121 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4122 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4123 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4124 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4125 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4127 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4128 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4129 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4132 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4133 @section Progress logging
4134 @cindex progress logging
4135 @cindex logging, of progress
4137 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4138 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4139 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a
4140 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4141 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4145 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4146 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4147 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4150 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4151 @subsection Closing items
4153 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4154 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4155 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4158 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4162 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4163 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4164 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4165 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4166 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4167 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4170 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4174 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4175 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4177 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4178 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4179 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4180 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4182 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4183 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4184 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4186 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4187 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4188 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4189 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4190 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4191 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4192 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4193 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4194 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4195 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4196 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4197 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4198 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4199 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4200 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4201 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4203 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4204 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4205 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4206 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4210 (setq org-todo-keywords
4211 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4214 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4215 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4218 @vindex org-log-done
4219 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4220 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4221 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4222 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4223 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4224 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4225 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4226 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4227 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4228 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4229 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4230 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4231 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4232 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4233 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4236 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4239 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4242 @cindex property, LOGGING
4243 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4244 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4245 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4246 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4247 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4248 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4251 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4253 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4255 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4257 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4259 * TODO No logging at all
4265 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4266 @subsection Tracking your habits
4269 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4270 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4274 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4277 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4279 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4281 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4282 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4283 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4284 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4286 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4287 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4288 three days, but at most every two days.
4290 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4291 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4292 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4293 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4296 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4297 actual habit with some history:
4301 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4302 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4303 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4304 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4305 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4306 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4307 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4308 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4309 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4310 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4311 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4314 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4318 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4319 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4320 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4321 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4322 after four days have elapsed.
4324 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4325 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4326 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4327 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4331 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4333 If the task could have been done on that day.
4335 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4337 If the task was overdue on that day.
4340 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4341 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4342 the current day falls in the graph.
4344 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4345 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4348 @item org-habit-graph-column
4349 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4350 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4351 titles brief and to the point.
4352 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4353 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4354 @item org-habit-following-days
4355 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4356 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4357 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4361 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4362 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4363 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4364 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4366 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4370 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4371 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4372 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4375 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4379 @vindex org-priority-faces
4380 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4381 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4382 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4383 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4384 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4385 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4387 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4393 @findex org-priority
4394 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4395 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4396 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4397 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4398 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4400 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4401 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4402 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4403 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4404 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4405 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4406 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4409 @vindex org-highest-priority
4410 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4411 @vindex org-default-priority
4412 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4413 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4414 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4415 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4416 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4419 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4424 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4425 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4426 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4427 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4429 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4430 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4431 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4432 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4433 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4434 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4435 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4436 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4437 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4440 * Organize Party [33%]
4441 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4445 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4448 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4449 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4450 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4451 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4454 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4455 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4456 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4457 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4458 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4462 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4464 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4468 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4469 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4472 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4473 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4474 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4475 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4477 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4481 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4482 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4485 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4489 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4490 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4491 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4492 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4493 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4494 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4495 in the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4496 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4497 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4498 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4500 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4503 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4504 - [-] call people [1/3]
4509 - [ ] think about what music to play
4510 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4513 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4514 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4515 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4518 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4519 @cindex checkbox statistics
4520 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4521 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4522 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4523 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4524 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4525 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4526 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4527 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4528 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4529 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4530 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4531 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4532 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4533 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4534 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4535 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4536 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4537 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4538 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4540 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4541 @cindex checkbox blocking
4542 @cindex property, ORDERED
4543 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4544 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4545 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4547 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4550 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4551 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4552 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4553 one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4554 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4555 considered to be an intermediate state.
4556 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4557 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4558 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4562 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4563 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4564 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4566 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4567 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4569 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4571 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4572 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4573 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4574 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4575 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4576 @cindex property, ORDERED
4577 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4578 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4579 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4580 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4581 for better visibility, customize the variable
4582 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4583 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4584 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4585 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4586 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4587 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4588 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4589 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4592 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4595 @cindex headline tagging
4596 @cindex matching, tags
4597 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4599 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4600 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4603 @vindex org-tag-faces
4604 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4605 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4606 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4607 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4608 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4609 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4610 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4611 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4614 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4615 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4616 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4619 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4620 @section Tag inheritance
4621 @cindex tag inheritance
4622 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4623 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4625 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4626 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4627 well. For example, in the list
4630 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4631 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4632 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4636 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4637 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4638 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4639 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4640 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4641 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4642 changes in the line.}:
4646 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4650 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4651 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4652 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4653 To turn it off entirely, use @code{org-use-tag-inheritance}.
4655 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4656 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4657 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4658 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4659 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4660 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4661 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4662 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4664 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
4665 Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag,
4666 either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda
4667 types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to
4668 have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine,
4669 with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control
4670 this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to nil
4671 can really speed up agenda generation.
4673 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4674 @section Setting tags
4675 @cindex setting tags
4676 @cindex tags, setting
4679 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4680 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4681 also a special command for inserting tags:
4684 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4685 @cindex completion, of tags
4686 @vindex org-tags-column
4687 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4688 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4689 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4690 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4691 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4692 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4693 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4694 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4695 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4698 @vindex org-tag-alist
4699 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4700 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4701 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4702 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4703 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4707 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4708 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4711 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4712 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4713 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4719 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4720 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4721 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4722 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4723 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4724 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4730 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4731 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4732 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4733 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4734 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4735 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4736 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4737 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4741 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4744 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4745 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4748 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4751 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4752 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4753 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4756 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4759 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4762 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4763 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4767 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4771 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4774 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4775 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4777 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4778 these lines to activate any changes.
4781 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4782 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4783 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4784 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4788 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4789 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4790 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4792 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4795 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4796 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4797 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4798 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4799 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4804 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4805 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4806 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4809 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4810 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4811 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4815 Clear all tags for this line.
4818 Accept the modified set.
4820 Abort without installing changes.
4822 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4824 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4825 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4827 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4828 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4833 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4834 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4835 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4836 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4837 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4838 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4839 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4840 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4842 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4843 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4844 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4845 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4846 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4847 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4848 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4849 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4850 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4851 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4852 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4854 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4855 @section Tag searches
4856 @cindex tag searches
4857 @cindex searching for tags
4859 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4860 information into special lists.
4863 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4864 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4865 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4866 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4867 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4868 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4869 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4870 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4871 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4872 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4873 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4876 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4877 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4878 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4879 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4880 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4881 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4882 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4885 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4886 @chapter Properties and columns
4889 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4890 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4891 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4893 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4894 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4895 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4896 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4897 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4898 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4899 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4900 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4901 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4903 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4904 (@pxref{Column view}).
4907 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4908 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4909 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4910 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4911 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4912 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4915 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4916 @section Property syntax
4917 @cindex property syntax
4918 @cindex drawer, for properties
4920 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4921 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4922 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4923 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4924 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4929 *** Goldberg Variations
4931 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4932 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4934 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4939 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4940 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4941 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4943 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4944 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4945 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4946 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4947 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4948 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4949 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4954 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4955 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4959 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4960 file, use a line like
4961 @cindex property, _ALL
4964 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4967 Contrary to properties set from a special drawer, you have to refresh the
4968 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-c} to activate this changes.
4970 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4971 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4972 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4975 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4976 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4979 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4980 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4981 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4989 *** Goldberg Variations
4991 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4992 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4994 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4999 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
5001 @vindex org-global-properties
5002 Property values set with the global variable
5003 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
5007 The following commands help to work with properties:
5010 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
5011 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
5012 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
5013 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
5014 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
5015 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
5016 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
5017 @cindex org-insert-drawer
5018 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
5019 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
5020 information like deadlines.
5021 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
5022 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
5023 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
5024 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
5025 can be inserted using completion.
5026 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
5027 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
5028 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
5029 Remove a property from the current entry.
5030 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
5031 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
5032 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
5033 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
5034 nearest column format definition.
5037 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
5038 @section Special properties
5039 @cindex properties, special
5041 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5042 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5043 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5044 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5045 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5046 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5048 @cindex property, special, ID
5049 @cindex property, special, TODO
5050 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5051 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5052 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5053 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5054 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5055 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5056 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5057 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5058 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5059 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5060 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5061 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5062 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5063 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5064 @cindex property, special, FILE
5066 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5067 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5068 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5069 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5070 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5071 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5072 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5073 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5074 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5075 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5076 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5077 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5078 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5079 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5080 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5081 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5082 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5083 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5084 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5085 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5088 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5089 @section Property searches
5090 @cindex properties, searching
5091 @cindex searching, of properties
5093 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5094 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5096 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5097 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5098 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5099 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5100 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5101 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5102 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5103 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5104 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5105 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5106 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5109 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5112 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5117 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5118 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5119 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5120 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5121 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5124 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5125 @section Property Inheritance
5126 @cindex properties, inheritance
5127 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5129 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5130 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5131 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5132 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5133 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5134 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5135 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5136 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5137 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5138 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5139 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5140 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5141 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5143 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5144 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5146 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5149 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5150 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5151 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5152 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5153 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5155 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5156 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5157 applies to the entire subtree.
5159 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5160 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5161 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5163 @cindex property, LOGGING
5164 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5165 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5168 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5169 @section Column view
5171 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5172 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5173 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5174 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5175 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5176 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5177 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5178 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5179 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5180 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5181 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5182 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5183 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5186 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5187 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5188 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5191 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5192 @subsection Defining columns
5193 @cindex column view, for properties
5194 @cindex properties, column view
5196 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5197 done by defining a column format line.
5200 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5201 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5204 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5205 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5207 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5211 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5214 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5215 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5218 ** Top node for columns view
5220 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5224 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5225 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5226 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5227 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5228 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5229 deeper part of the tree.
5231 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5232 @subsubsection Column attributes
5233 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5234 definition looks like this:
5237 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5241 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5242 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5245 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5246 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5247 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5248 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5249 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5250 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5252 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5253 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5254 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5255 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5256 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5257 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5258 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5259 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5260 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5261 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5262 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5263 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5264 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5265 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5266 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5267 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5268 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5269 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5270 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5271 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5275 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5276 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5277 same summary information.
5279 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5280 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5281 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5282 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5283 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5284 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5286 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5287 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5288 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5289 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5290 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5291 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5292 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5293 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5295 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5299 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5300 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5301 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5302 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5303 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5307 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5308 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5309 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5310 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5311 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5312 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5313 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5314 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5315 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5316 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5317 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5318 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5319 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5320 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5323 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5324 @subsection Using column view
5327 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5328 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5329 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5330 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5331 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5332 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5333 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5334 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5335 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5336 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5337 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5338 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5339 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5340 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5341 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5343 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5345 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5346 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5347 Move through the column view from field to field.
5348 @kindex S-@key{left}
5349 @kindex S-@key{right}
5350 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5351 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5352 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5354 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5355 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5356 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5357 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5358 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5359 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5360 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5361 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5362 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5363 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5364 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5365 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5366 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5367 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5368 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5369 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5370 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5371 current column view.
5372 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5373 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5374 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5375 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5376 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5377 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5378 Delete the current column.
5381 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5382 @subsection Capturing column view
5384 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5385 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5386 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5387 of this block looks like this:
5389 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5392 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5397 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5401 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5402 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5403 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5404 capture, you can use 4 values:
5405 @cindex property, ID
5407 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5408 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5409 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5410 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5411 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5412 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5413 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5414 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5417 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5418 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5420 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5422 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5423 @item :skip-empty-rows
5424 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5425 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5430 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5433 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5434 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5435 for the scope or ID of the view.
5436 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5437 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5438 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5439 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5440 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5441 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5445 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5446 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5447 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5448 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5450 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5451 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5452 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5453 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5454 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5455 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5456 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5458 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5459 @section The Property API
5460 @cindex properties, API
5461 @cindex API, for properties
5463 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5464 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5465 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5468 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5469 @chapter Dates and times
5475 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5476 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5477 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5478 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5479 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5480 is used in a much wider sense.
5483 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5484 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5485 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5486 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5487 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5488 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5489 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5493 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5494 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5496 @cindex ranges, time
5501 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5502 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5503 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5504 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5505 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5506 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5507 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5508 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5509 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5510 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5513 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5516 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5517 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5518 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5519 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5522 * Meet Peter at the movies
5523 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5524 * Discussion on climate change
5525 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5528 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5529 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5530 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5531 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5532 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5533 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5536 * Pick up Sam at school
5537 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5540 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5541 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5542 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5543 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5544 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5545 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5546 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5547 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5548 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5549 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5550 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5551 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5552 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5553 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5554 example with optional time
5557 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5558 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5561 @item Time/Date range
5564 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5565 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5566 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5569 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5570 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5573 @item Inactive timestamp
5574 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5575 @cindex inactive timestamp
5576 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5577 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5578 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5581 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5587 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5588 @section Creating timestamps
5589 @cindex creating timestamps
5590 @cindex timestamps, creating
5592 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5593 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5597 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5598 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5599 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5600 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5601 succession, a time range is inserted.
5603 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5604 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5611 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5612 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5613 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5614 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5617 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5619 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5620 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5622 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5623 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5624 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5627 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5628 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5629 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5631 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5632 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5633 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5635 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5636 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5637 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5638 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5639 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5640 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5641 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5642 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5643 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5645 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5646 @cindex evaluate time range
5647 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5648 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5649 the following column).
5654 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5655 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5658 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5659 @subsection The date/time prompt
5660 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5661 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5663 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5664 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5665 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5666 format. But it will in fact accept date/time information in a variety of
5667 formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning of the
5668 string. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5669 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5670 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5671 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5672 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5673 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5674 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5675 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5676 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5677 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5678 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5679 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5681 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5682 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5686 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5687 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5688 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5689 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5690 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5691 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5692 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5693 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5694 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5695 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5696 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5697 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5698 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5699 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5702 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5703 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5704 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5705 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5706 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5707 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5708 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5713 +4d @result{} four days from today
5714 +4 @result{} same as above
5715 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5716 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5717 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5720 @vindex parse-time-months
5721 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5722 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5723 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5724 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5726 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5727 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5728 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5729 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5730 read the docstring of the variable
5731 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5733 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5734 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5735 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5739 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5740 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5741 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5744 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5745 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5746 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5747 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5748 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5749 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5750 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5751 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5752 from the minibuffer:
5759 @kindex S-@key{right}
5760 @kindex S-@key{left}
5761 @kindex S-@key{down}
5763 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5764 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5767 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5768 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5769 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5770 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5771 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5772 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5773 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5776 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5777 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5778 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5779 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5780 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5781 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5782 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5784 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5785 @subsection Custom time format
5786 @cindex custom date/time format
5787 @cindex time format, custom
5788 @cindex date format, custom
5790 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5791 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5792 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5793 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5794 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5795 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5796 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5799 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5800 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5804 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5805 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5806 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5807 following consequences:
5810 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5813 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5814 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5815 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5816 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5817 time will be changed by one minute.
5819 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5820 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5822 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5823 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5824 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5826 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5827 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5828 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5832 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5833 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5835 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5839 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5841 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5842 to be finished on that date.
5844 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5845 @vindex org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled
5846 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5847 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5848 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5849 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5850 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5853 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5854 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5855 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5858 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5859 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5860 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}. This warning is
5861 deactivated if the task get scheduled and you set
5862 @code{org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled} to @code{t}.
5865 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5867 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5870 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5871 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5872 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5873 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5874 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5875 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5876 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5879 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5880 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5883 @vindex org-scheduled-delay-days
5884 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline
5885 If you want to @emph{delay} the display of this task in the agenda, use
5886 @code{SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>}: the task is still scheduled on the
5887 25th but will appear two days later. In case the task contains a repeater,
5888 the delay is considered to affect all occurrences; if you want it to affect
5889 only the first scheduled occurrence of the task, use @code{--2d} instead.
5890 See @code{org-scheduled-delay-days} and
5891 @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline} for details on how to
5892 control this globally or per agenda.
5895 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5896 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5897 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5898 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5899 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5900 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5901 want to start working on an action item.
5904 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5905 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5906 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5907 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5909 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5911 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5912 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5913 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5917 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5918 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5921 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5922 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5924 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5925 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5926 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5931 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5932 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5933 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5934 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5935 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5936 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5937 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5940 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5941 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5942 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5943 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5944 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5945 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5946 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5947 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5950 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5953 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5954 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5955 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5956 schedule the marked item.
5958 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5959 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5960 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5961 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5962 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5963 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5964 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5965 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5967 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5968 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5970 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5971 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5974 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5975 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5976 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5977 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5979 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5980 @subsection Repeated tasks
5981 @cindex tasks, repeated
5982 @cindex repeated tasks
5984 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5985 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5986 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5988 ** TODO Pay the rent
5989 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5992 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5993 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5994 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5995 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5996 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5997 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5999 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
6000 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
6001 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
6002 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
6003 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
6004 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
6005 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
6006 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
6007 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
6008 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
6009 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
6010 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
6011 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
6012 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
6013 switch the date like this:
6016 ** TODO Pay the rent
6017 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
6020 @vindex org-log-repeat
6021 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
6022 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
6023 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
6024 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
6025 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
6027 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
6028 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
6031 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
6032 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
6033 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
6034 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
6035 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
6036 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
6037 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
6038 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
6039 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
6043 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
6044 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
6045 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
6046 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
6047 and marked it done on Saturday.
6048 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
6049 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
6050 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
6054 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
6055 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
6057 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6058 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6059 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6062 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6063 @section Clocking work time
6064 @cindex clocking time
6065 @cindex time clocking
6067 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6068 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6069 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6070 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6071 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6072 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6073 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6074 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6075 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6077 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6079 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6080 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6082 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6083 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6084 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6085 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6089 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6090 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6091 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6094 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6095 @subsection Clocking commands
6098 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6099 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6100 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6101 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6102 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6103 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6104 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6105 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6106 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6107 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6108 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6109 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6110 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6111 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6112 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6113 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6114 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6115 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6116 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6117 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6118 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6119 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6120 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6121 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6122 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6123 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6124 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6125 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6126 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6127 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6128 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6129 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6130 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6131 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6132 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6133 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6135 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6136 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6137 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6138 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6139 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6140 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6141 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6142 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6143 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6144 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6145 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6146 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6147 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6148 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6150 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6151 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6154 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6155 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6156 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6157 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6158 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6159 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6160 clock duration keeps the same.
6161 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6162 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6163 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6164 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6165 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6166 increased by five minutes.
6167 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6168 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6169 if it is running in this same item.
6170 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6171 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6172 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6173 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6174 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6175 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6176 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6177 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6178 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6179 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6180 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6181 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6182 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6186 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6187 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6188 worked on or closed during a day.
6190 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6191 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6192 modify the window disposition.
6194 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6195 @subsection The clock table
6196 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6197 @cindex report, of clocked time
6199 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6200 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6201 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6204 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6205 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6206 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6207 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6208 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6209 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6210 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6211 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6212 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6213 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6214 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6215 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6216 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6217 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6218 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6219 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6220 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6224 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6225 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6227 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6229 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6233 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6234 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6235 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6236 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6238 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6241 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6242 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6243 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6244 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6245 file @r{the full current buffer}
6246 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6247 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6248 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6249 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6250 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6251 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6252 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6253 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6254 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6256 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6257 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6258 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6259 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6260 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6261 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6262 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6263 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6264 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6265 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6266 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6267 @r{Relative times like @code{"<-2w>"} can also be used. See}
6268 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax.}
6269 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6270 @r{Relative times like @code{"<now>"} can also be used. See}
6271 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax.}
6272 :wstart @r{The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for monday.}
6273 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6274 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6275 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6276 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6277 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6278 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6281 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6282 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6283 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6285 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6286 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6287 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6288 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6289 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6290 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6291 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6292 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6293 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6294 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6295 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6296 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6297 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6298 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6299 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6300 @r{property will get its own column.}
6301 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6302 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6303 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6304 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6305 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6306 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6308 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6309 day, you could write
6311 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6315 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6316 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6317 only to fit it into the manual.}
6319 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6320 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6323 A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as
6325 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "<now>"
6328 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6330 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6333 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6336 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6340 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6341 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6343 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6344 @cindex resolve idle time
6345 @vindex org-clock-x11idle-program-name
6347 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6348 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6349 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6350 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6351 applying it to another one.
6353 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6354 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6355 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6356 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6357 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6358 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6359 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, or install the
6360 @file{xprintidle} package and set it to the variable
6361 @code{org-clock-x11idle-program-name} if you are running Debian, to get the
6362 same general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to
6363 Emacs idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time.
6364 There will be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how
6365 much idle time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as
6366 well as a set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6370 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6371 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6372 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6374 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6375 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6376 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6378 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6379 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6381 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6382 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6383 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6385 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6386 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6387 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6388 log with an empty entry.
6391 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6392 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6393 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6394 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6395 the next task you clock in on.
6397 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6398 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6399 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6400 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6401 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6403 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6404 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6405 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6406 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6407 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6408 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6410 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6411 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6413 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6414 @cindex continuous clocking
6415 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6417 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6418 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6419 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6420 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6422 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6423 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6425 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6426 @section Effort estimates
6427 @cindex effort estimates
6429 @cindex property, Effort
6430 @vindex org-effort-property
6431 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6432 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6433 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6434 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6435 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6436 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6437 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6438 for an entry with the following commands:
6441 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6442 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6443 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6444 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6445 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6446 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6449 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6450 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6451 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6452 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6456 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6457 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6461 @vindex org-global-properties
6462 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6463 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6464 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6465 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6466 setup may be advised.
6468 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6469 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6470 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6471 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6473 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6474 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6475 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6476 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6477 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6478 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6479 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6480 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6481 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6483 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6484 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6485 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6486 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6488 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6489 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6490 @cindex relative timer
6492 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6493 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6494 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6497 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6498 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6499 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6501 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6502 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6503 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6504 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6505 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6507 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6510 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6511 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6512 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6513 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6515 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6516 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6517 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6518 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6519 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6520 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6521 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6522 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6523 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6524 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6525 not started at exactly the right moment.
6528 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6529 @section Countdown timer
6530 @cindex Countdown timer
6534 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6535 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6537 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6538 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6539 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6542 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6543 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6546 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6547 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6548 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6549 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6550 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6551 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6554 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6555 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6556 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6557 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6558 * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another
6559 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6562 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6566 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6567 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6568 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6569 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6570 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6572 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6573 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6575 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6577 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6578 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6579 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6580 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6582 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6583 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6584 does enhance it with templates and more.
6587 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6588 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6589 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6592 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6593 @subsection Setting up capture
6595 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6596 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6597 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6599 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6601 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6602 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6605 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6606 @subsection Using capture
6609 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6610 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6611 not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates
6613 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6614 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6615 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6616 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6618 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6619 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6620 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6621 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6622 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6624 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6625 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refile and copy}) the note to
6626 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6627 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6628 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6629 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6630 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6632 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6633 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6637 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6638 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6639 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6640 rather than to the current date.
6642 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6647 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6648 template in the usual way.
6649 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6650 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6653 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6654 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6655 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6656 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6659 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6660 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6662 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6663 @subsection Capture templates
6664 @cindex templates, for Capture
6666 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6667 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6668 through the customize interface.
6672 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6675 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6676 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6677 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6678 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6679 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6683 (setq org-capture-templates
6684 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6685 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6686 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6687 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6690 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6694 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6698 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6699 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6700 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6701 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6702 place where you started the capture process.
6704 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6705 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6709 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6710 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6714 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6715 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6716 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6719 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6720 @subsubsection Template elements
6722 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6723 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6727 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6728 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6729 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6730 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6731 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6732 prefix key, for example
6734 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6736 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6737 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6740 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6744 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6747 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6748 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6750 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6751 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6753 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6756 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6757 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6758 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6760 Text to be inserted as it is.
6764 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6765 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6766 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6767 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6768 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6769 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6770 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6774 @item (file "path/to/file")
6775 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6777 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6778 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6780 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6781 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6783 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6784 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6786 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6787 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6789 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6790 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6792 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6793 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6795 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6796 A function to find the right location in the file.
6799 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6801 @item (function function-finding-location)
6802 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6807 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6808 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6809 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6810 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6811 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6815 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6816 Recognized properties are:
6819 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6820 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6821 Setting this property will change that.
6823 @item :immediate-finish
6824 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6825 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6826 information that can be added automatically.
6829 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6830 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6833 Start the clock in this item.
6836 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6839 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6840 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6841 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6842 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6845 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6846 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6848 @item :table-line-pos
6849 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6850 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6851 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6855 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6856 buffer again after capture is completed.
6860 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6861 @subsubsection Template expansion
6863 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6864 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6865 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6868 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6869 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6870 @r{For convenience, %:keyword (see below) placeholders}
6871 @r{within the expression will be expanded prior to this.}
6872 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6873 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6874 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6875 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6876 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6877 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6878 @r{region is active.}
6879 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6880 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6881 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6882 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6883 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6884 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6885 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6886 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6887 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6888 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6889 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6890 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6891 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6892 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6893 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6894 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6895 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6896 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6897 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6898 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6899 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6900 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6901 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6902 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6903 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6904 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6908 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6909 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6910 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6911 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6914 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6916 Link type | Available keywords
6917 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6918 bbdb | %:name %:company
6919 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6920 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6921 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6922 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6923 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6924 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6925 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6926 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6927 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6929 info | %:file %:node
6934 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6937 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6940 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6941 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6943 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6944 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6945 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6946 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6947 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6950 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6951 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6954 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6955 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6958 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6959 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6962 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6964 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6965 @section Attachments
6968 @vindex org-attach-directory
6969 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6970 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6971 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6972 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6973 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6974 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6975 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6976 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6977 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6978 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6979 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6980 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6981 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6983 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6984 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6985 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6988 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6992 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6993 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6994 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6995 to select a command:
6998 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6999 @vindex org-attach-method
7000 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
7001 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
7002 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
7008 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
7009 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
7011 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
7012 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
7014 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
7015 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
7016 attachments yourself.
7018 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
7019 @vindex org-file-apps
7020 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
7021 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
7022 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
7023 (@pxref{Handling links}).
7025 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
7026 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
7028 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
7029 Open the current task's attachment directory.
7031 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
7032 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
7034 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
7035 Select and delete a single attachment.
7037 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
7038 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
7039 @command{dired} and delete from there.
7041 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
7042 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
7043 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
7044 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
7046 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
7047 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
7048 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
7049 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
7053 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
7058 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
7059 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
7060 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
7061 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
7062 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
7063 information. Here is just an example:
7066 (setq org-feed-alist
7068 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7069 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7073 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7074 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7075 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7076 the following command is used:
7079 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7081 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7083 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7084 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7087 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7088 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7089 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7090 list of drawers in that file:
7093 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7096 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7097 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7099 @node Protocols, Refile and copy, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7100 @section Protocols for external access
7101 @cindex protocols, for external access
7104 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7105 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7106 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7107 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7108 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7109 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7110 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7111 documentation and setup instructions.
7113 @node Refile and copy, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7114 @section Refile and copy
7115 @cindex refiling notes
7116 @cindex copying notes
7118 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy some of
7119 the entries into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting,
7120 finding the right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To
7121 simplify this process, you can use the following special command:
7124 @orgcmd{C-c M-w,org-copy}
7126 Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not deleted.
7127 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7129 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7130 @vindex org-refile-targets
7131 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7132 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7133 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7134 @vindex org-log-refile
7135 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7136 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7137 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7138 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7139 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7141 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7142 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7143 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7144 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7145 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7146 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7147 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7148 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7149 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7150 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7151 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7152 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7153 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7154 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7155 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7156 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7158 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7159 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7160 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7161 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7162 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7165 @node Archiving, , Refile and copy, Capture - Refile - Archive
7169 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7170 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7171 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7172 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7175 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7176 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7177 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7178 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7182 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7183 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7186 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7187 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7188 @cindex external archiving
7190 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7194 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7195 @vindex org-archive-location
7196 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7197 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7198 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7199 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7200 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7201 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7202 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7203 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7206 @cindex archive locations
7207 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7208 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7209 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7210 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7211 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7212 see the documentation string of the variable
7213 @code{org-archive-location}.
7215 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7216 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7217 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7218 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7219 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7220 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7221 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7222 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7226 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7229 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7231 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7232 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7233 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7235 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7236 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7237 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7238 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7239 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7243 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7244 @subsection Internal archiving
7246 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7247 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7249 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7250 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7253 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7254 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7255 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7256 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7257 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7258 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7260 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7261 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7262 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7263 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7265 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7266 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7267 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7268 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7269 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7270 temporarily included.
7272 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7273 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7274 is. Configure the details using the variable
7275 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7277 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7278 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7279 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7282 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7285 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7286 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7287 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7289 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7290 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7291 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7292 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7293 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7294 level 1 trees will be checked.
7295 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7296 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7297 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7298 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7299 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7300 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7301 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7306 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7307 @chapter Agenda views
7308 @cindex agenda views
7310 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7311 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7312 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7313 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7314 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7316 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7317 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7321 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7324 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7327 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7328 TODO state associated with them,
7330 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7331 in time-sorted view,
7333 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7334 that contain specified keywords,
7336 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7339 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7344 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7345 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7346 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7347 edit these files remotely.
7349 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7350 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7351 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7352 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7353 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7354 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7357 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7358 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7359 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7360 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7361 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7362 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7363 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7364 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7367 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7368 @section Agenda files
7369 @cindex agenda files
7370 @cindex files for agenda
7372 @vindex org-agenda-files
7373 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7374 files}, the files listed in the variable
7375 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7376 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7377 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7378 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7381 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7382 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7383 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7384 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7385 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7386 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7388 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7390 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7391 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7392 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7393 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7394 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7395 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7397 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7398 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7400 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7401 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7402 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7403 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7408 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7409 to visit any of them.
7411 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7412 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7413 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7414 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7415 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7416 extended period, use the following commands:
7419 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7420 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7421 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7422 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7423 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7424 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7425 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7426 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7427 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7431 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7434 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7435 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7436 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7437 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7439 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7440 Lift the restriction.
7443 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7444 @section The agenda dispatcher
7445 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7446 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7447 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7448 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7449 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7450 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7451 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7452 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7455 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7457 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7459 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7460 tags and properties}).
7462 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7464 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7465 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7467 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7468 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7469 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7470 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7471 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7474 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7476 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7477 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7478 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7479 selecting the command.
7481 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7482 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7483 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7484 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7485 character selecting the command.
7488 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7489 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7490 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7491 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7492 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7493 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7494 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7495 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7496 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7499 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7500 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7501 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7502 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7503 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7505 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7506 @section The built-in agenda views
7508 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7511 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7512 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7513 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7514 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7515 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7516 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7519 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7520 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7522 @cindex weekly agenda
7523 @cindex daily agenda
7525 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7526 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7529 @cindex org-agenda, command
7530 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7531 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7532 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7533 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7534 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7535 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7536 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7539 @vindex org-agenda-span
7540 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7541 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7542 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7543 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7544 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7547 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7548 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7549 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7552 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7553 @cindex calendar integration
7554 @cindex diary integration
7556 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7557 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7558 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7559 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7560 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7561 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7564 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7565 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7568 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7571 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7572 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7573 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7574 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7575 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7576 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7577 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7578 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7579 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7580 between calendar and agenda.
7582 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7583 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7584 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7585 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7586 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7587 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7588 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7589 will be made in the agenda:
7592 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7594 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7596 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7597 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7600 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7601 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7602 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7604 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7605 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7606 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7607 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7608 following to one of your agenda files:
7615 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7618 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7619 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7620 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7621 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7622 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7623 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7624 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7630 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7633 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7634 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7635 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7636 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7637 in an Org or Diary file.
7639 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7640 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7641 @cindex appointment reminders
7645 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7646 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7647 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7648 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7649 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7650 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7651 docstring for details.
7653 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7654 @subsection The global TODO list
7655 @cindex global TODO list
7656 @cindex TODO list, global
7658 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7659 collected into a single place.
7662 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7663 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7664 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7665 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7666 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7667 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7668 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7669 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7670 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7671 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7672 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7673 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7674 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7675 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7677 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7678 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7679 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7680 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7681 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7682 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7685 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7686 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7687 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7689 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7690 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7691 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7695 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7696 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7697 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7698 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7699 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7700 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7701 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7702 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7703 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7704 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7707 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7708 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7709 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7710 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7711 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7714 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7715 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7716 @cindex matching, of tags
7717 @cindex matching, of properties
7721 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7722 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7723 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7724 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7728 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7729 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7730 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7731 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7732 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7733 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7734 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7735 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7736 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7737 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7738 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7739 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7740 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7741 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7745 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7748 @subsubheading Match syntax
7750 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7751 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7752 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7753 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7754 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7755 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7756 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7757 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7758 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7762 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7765 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7766 @item work|laptop+night
7767 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7771 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7772 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7773 braces. For example,
7774 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7775 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7777 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7778 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7779 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7780 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7781 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7782 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7783 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7784 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7785 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7786 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7787 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7788 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7789 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7790 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7791 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7792 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7794 Here are more examples:
7796 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7797 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7798 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7799 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7800 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7803 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7804 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7807 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7808 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7812 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7815 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7816 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7817 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7819 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7820 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7822 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7823 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7824 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7825 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7826 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7827 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7828 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7829 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7830 respectively, can be used.
7832 If the comparison value is enclosed
7833 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7834 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7838 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7839 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7840 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7841 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7842 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7843 on or after October 11, 2008.
7845 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7846 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7847 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7850 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7851 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7852 inheritance}, for details.
7854 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7855 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7856 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7857 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7858 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7859 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7860 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7861 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7862 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7863 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7864 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7865 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7869 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7870 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7871 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7873 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7874 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7878 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7879 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7880 @cindex timeline, single file
7881 @cindex time-sorted view
7883 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7884 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7885 to give an overview over events in a project.
7888 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7889 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7890 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7891 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7895 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7896 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7898 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7899 @subsection Search view
7902 @cindex searching, for text
7904 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7905 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7908 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7909 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7910 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7912 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7913 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7914 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7915 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7916 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7917 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7918 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7919 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7920 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7921 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7922 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7924 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7925 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7926 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7928 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7929 @subsection Stuck projects
7930 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7932 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7933 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7934 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7935 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7936 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7937 projects and define next actions for them.
7940 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7941 List projects that are stuck.
7944 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7945 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7946 project is and how to find it.
7949 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7950 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7951 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7952 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7954 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7955 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7956 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7957 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7958 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7959 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7960 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7961 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7962 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7963 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7964 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7965 correct customization for this is
7968 (setq org-stuck-projects
7969 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7973 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7974 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7976 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7977 @section Presentation and sorting
7978 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7980 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7981 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7982 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7983 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7984 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7985 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7986 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7987 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7988 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7989 associated with the item.
7992 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7993 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7994 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7997 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7998 @subsection Categories
8002 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
8003 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
8004 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
8005 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
8006 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
8007 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
8008 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
8009 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
8010 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
8018 @cindex property, CATEGORY
8019 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
8020 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
8021 special category you want to apply as the value.
8024 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
8025 longer than 10 characters.
8028 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
8029 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
8031 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
8032 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
8033 @cindex time-of-day specification
8035 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
8036 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
8037 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
8038 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
8040 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
8042 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
8043 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
8044 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
8045 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
8047 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
8048 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
8049 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
8052 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8053 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8054 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8055 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8059 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
8060 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
8063 8:00...... ------------------
8064 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8065 10:00...... ------------------
8066 12:00...... ------------------
8067 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8068 14:00...... ------------------
8069 16:00...... ------------------
8070 18:00...... ------------------
8071 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8072 20:00...... ------------------
8073 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8076 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8077 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8078 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8079 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8080 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8082 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8083 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
8084 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8085 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8086 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8087 done depends on the type of view.
8090 @vindex org-agenda-files
8091 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8092 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8093 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8094 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8095 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8096 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8097 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8098 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8099 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8101 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8102 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8103 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8104 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8107 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8108 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8111 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8112 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8113 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8114 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8116 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8117 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8118 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8120 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8121 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8122 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8123 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8124 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8125 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8127 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8128 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8131 @tsubheading{Motion}
8132 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8133 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8134 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8135 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8136 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8137 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8138 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8139 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8140 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8141 outline, not only the heading.
8143 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8144 Display original location and recenter that window.
8146 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8147 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8149 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8150 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8152 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8153 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8154 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8155 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8156 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8157 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8158 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8160 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8161 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8162 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8163 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8164 previously used indirect buffer.
8166 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8167 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8168 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8169 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8171 @tsubheading{Change display}
8172 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8175 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8179 Delete other windows.
8181 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8182 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8183 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8184 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8185 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8186 @vindex org-agenda-span
8187 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8188 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8189 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8190 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8191 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8192 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8193 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8194 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8195 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8196 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8197 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8199 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8200 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8201 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8202 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8204 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8205 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8207 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8210 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8211 Prompt for a date and go there.
8213 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8214 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8216 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8217 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8219 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8221 @vindex org-log-done
8222 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8223 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8224 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8225 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8226 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8227 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8228 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8229 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8230 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8232 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8233 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8234 agenda and timeline views.
8236 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8237 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8238 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8239 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8240 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8241 press @kbd{v a} again.
8243 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8244 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8245 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8246 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8247 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8248 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8249 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8250 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8251 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8252 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8253 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8254 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8257 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8258 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8259 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8260 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8261 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8262 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8265 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8266 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8267 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8268 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8269 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8270 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8271 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8272 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8274 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8275 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8276 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8277 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8278 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8280 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8281 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8282 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8283 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8284 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8286 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8289 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8290 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8293 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8294 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8295 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8296 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8297 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8298 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8299 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8300 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8302 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8303 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8304 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8306 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8307 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8308 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8309 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8310 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8311 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8313 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8314 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8316 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8317 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8318 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8321 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8322 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8323 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8324 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8325 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8326 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8327 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8328 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8329 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8330 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8331 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8333 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8334 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8335 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8336 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8337 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8338 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8339 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8340 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8341 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8342 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8344 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8345 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8346 efforts globally, for example
8348 (setq org-global-properties
8349 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8351 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8352 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8353 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8354 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8355 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0--9 are not used
8356 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8357 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8358 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8359 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8360 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8362 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8363 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8364 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8365 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8366 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8367 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8368 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8369 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8370 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8374 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8376 ((string= tag "Net")
8377 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8378 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8379 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8380 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8381 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8384 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8388 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8389 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8390 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8391 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8392 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8401 @item @r{in} search view
8402 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8403 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8404 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8405 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8406 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8410 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8411 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8416 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8417 @cindex remote editing, undo
8418 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8419 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8420 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8422 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8423 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8426 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8427 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8428 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8430 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8431 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8432 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8433 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8434 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8435 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8437 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8438 Refile the entry at point.
8440 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8441 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8442 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8443 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8444 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8446 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8447 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8449 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8450 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8453 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8454 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8455 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8458 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8459 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8460 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8461 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8462 tags of a headline occasionally.
8464 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8465 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8466 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8470 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8471 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8472 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8474 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8475 Display weighted priority of current item.
8477 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8478 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8479 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8482 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8483 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8485 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8486 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8487 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8488 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8489 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8491 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8492 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8494 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8495 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8497 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8498 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8500 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8501 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8502 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8504 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8505 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8506 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8507 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8508 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8509 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8510 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8512 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8513 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8516 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8517 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8518 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8520 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8521 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8524 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8525 Stop the previously started clock.
8527 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8528 Cancel the currently running clock.
8530 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8531 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8533 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8534 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8535 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8536 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8537 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8538 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8540 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8541 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8542 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8543 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8545 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8546 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8549 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8550 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8552 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8553 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8555 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8556 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8558 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8559 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8560 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8561 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8562 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8563 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8564 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8567 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8568 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8569 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8570 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8571 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8572 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8573 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8574 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8575 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8576 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8577 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8578 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8579 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8580 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8581 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8582 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8583 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8584 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8586 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8587 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8588 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8589 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8590 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8591 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8592 @r{ (save-excursion}
8593 @r{ (save-restriction}
8595 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8596 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8597 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8601 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8602 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8604 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8605 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8607 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8608 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8611 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8612 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8613 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8614 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8615 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8616 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8617 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8618 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8619 you can add the entry.
8621 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8622 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8623 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8624 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8625 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8626 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8627 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8628 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8629 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8630 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8632 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8633 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8635 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8636 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8637 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8639 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8640 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8643 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8644 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8646 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8647 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8648 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8650 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8651 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8652 @cindex exporting agenda views
8653 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8654 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8655 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8656 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8657 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8658 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8659 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8660 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8661 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8663 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8664 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8665 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8667 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8668 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8669 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8670 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8671 visit Org files will not be removed.
8675 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8676 @section Custom agenda views
8677 @cindex custom agenda views
8678 @cindex agenda views, custom
8680 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8681 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8682 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8683 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8686 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8687 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8688 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8691 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8692 @subsection Storing searches
8694 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8695 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8696 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8699 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8700 @cindex agenda views, main example
8701 @cindex tags, as an agenda view
8702 @cindex todo, as an agenda view
8708 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8709 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8710 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8711 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8716 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8717 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8718 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8719 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8720 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8721 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8722 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8723 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8724 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8725 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8726 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8731 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8732 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8733 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8734 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8735 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8736 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8737 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8738 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8739 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8744 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8747 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8748 results as a sparse tree
8750 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8753 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8754 headlines that are also TODO items
8756 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8757 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8759 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8760 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8762 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8763 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8764 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8767 Note that the @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an
8768 Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only.
8770 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8771 @subsection Block agenda
8772 @cindex block agenda
8773 @cindex agenda, with block views
8775 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8776 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8777 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8778 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8779 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8780 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8781 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8785 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8786 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8790 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8798 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8799 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8800 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8801 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8802 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8804 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8805 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8806 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8808 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8809 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8810 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8811 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8812 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8813 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8814 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8818 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8819 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8820 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8821 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8822 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8823 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8824 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8826 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8827 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8832 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8833 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8834 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8835 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8836 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8837 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8838 to only a single file.
8840 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8841 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8842 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8843 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8844 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8845 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8846 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8847 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8848 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8849 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8850 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8854 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8855 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8859 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8860 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8861 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8868 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8869 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8870 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8871 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8872 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8875 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8876 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8877 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8878 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8879 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8883 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8884 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8887 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8888 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8891 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8892 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8895 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8897 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8898 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8899 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8901 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8902 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8903 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8904 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8905 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8906 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8907 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8910 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8911 @cindex exporting agenda views
8912 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8913 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8914 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8915 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8916 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8917 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8918 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8919 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8921 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8922 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8923 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8924 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8926 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8927 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8928 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8929 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8930 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8934 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8935 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8936 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8937 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8938 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8939 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8940 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8941 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8942 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8947 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8948 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8949 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8950 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8955 ("~/views/home.html"))
8956 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8961 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8965 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8966 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8967 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8968 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8969 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8970 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8971 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8972 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8974 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8975 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8976 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8980 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8981 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8985 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8986 set options for the export commands. For example:
8989 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8991 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8992 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8993 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8994 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8995 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
9000 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
9001 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
9002 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
9003 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
9004 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
9005 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
9006 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
9007 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
9008 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
9011 From the command line you may also use
9013 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
9016 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
9017 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
9019 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
9020 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
9021 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
9022 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
9023 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
9027 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
9028 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
9031 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
9032 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
9036 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
9037 @section Using column view in the agenda
9038 @cindex column view, in agenda
9039 @cindex agenda, column view
9041 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
9042 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
9043 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
9044 collected by certain criteria.
9047 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
9048 Turn on column view in the agenda.
9051 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
9052 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
9053 This causes the following issues:
9057 @vindex org-columns-default-format
9058 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
9059 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
9060 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
9061 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
9062 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
9063 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
9064 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
9065 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
9066 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
9068 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
9069 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
9070 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
9071 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
9072 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
9073 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
9074 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
9075 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
9076 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
9077 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
9078 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
9079 some values will count double.
9081 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
9082 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
9083 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9084 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9085 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9086 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9087 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9091 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9092 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9093 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9094 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9095 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9096 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9100 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9101 @chapter Markup for rich export
9103 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9104 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9105 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9106 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9107 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9110 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9111 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9112 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9113 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9114 * Index entries:: Making an index
9115 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9116 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9119 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9120 @section Structural markup elements
9123 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9124 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9125 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9126 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9128 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9129 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9130 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9131 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9132 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9135 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9136 @subheading Document title
9137 @cindex document title, markup rules
9140 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9144 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9148 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9149 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9150 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9151 title will be the file name without extension.
9153 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9154 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9155 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9156 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9158 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9159 @subheading Headings and sections
9160 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9162 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9163 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9164 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9165 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9166 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9167 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9168 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9169 per-file basis with a line
9176 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9177 @subheading Table of contents
9178 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9180 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9181 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9182 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9183 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9184 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9185 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9186 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9187 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9190 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9191 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9194 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9195 @subheading Text before the first headline
9196 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9199 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9200 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9201 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9202 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9204 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9205 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9206 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9207 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9208 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9209 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9212 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9213 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9217 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9218 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9219 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9222 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9224 @cindex lists, markup rules
9226 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9227 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9230 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9231 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9232 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9234 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9235 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9237 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9238 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9240 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9243 Great clouds overhead
9244 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9251 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9252 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9253 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9255 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9258 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9259 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9263 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9264 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9267 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9273 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9274 @subheading Footnote markup
9275 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9276 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9278 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9279 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9280 multiple footnotes side by side.
9282 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9283 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9285 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9286 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9287 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9288 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9289 @cindex code text, markup rules
9290 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9291 @vindex org-fontify-emphasized-text
9292 @vindex org-emphasis-regexp-components
9293 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9294 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9295 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9296 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9298 To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set
9299 @code{org-fontify-emphasized-text} to @code{nil}. To fine tune what
9300 characters are allowed before and after the special characters, see
9301 @code{org-emphasis-regexp-components}.
9303 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9304 @subheading Horizontal rules
9305 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9306 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9307 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9309 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9310 @subheading Comment lines
9311 @cindex comment lines
9312 @cindex exporting, not
9313 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9315 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9316 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9317 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9318 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9319 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9324 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9328 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9329 @section Images and Tables
9331 @cindex tables, markup rules
9334 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9335 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9336 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9337 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9338 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9339 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9342 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9343 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9348 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9350 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9353 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9354 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9355 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9356 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9357 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9358 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9359 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9362 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9363 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9367 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9368 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9371 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9373 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9374 @section Literal examples
9375 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9376 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9378 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9379 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9380 for source code and similar examples.
9381 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9385 Some example from a text file.
9389 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9390 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9391 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9392 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9393 whitespace before the colon:
9397 : Some example from a text file.
9400 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9401 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9402 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9403 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9404 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9405 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9406 achieved using either the listings or the
9407 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9408 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9409 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9410 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9411 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9412 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9413 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9418 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9419 (defun org-xor (a b)
9425 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9426 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9427 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9428 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9429 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9430 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9431 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9432 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9435 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9436 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9437 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9438 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9439 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9440 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9444 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9445 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9446 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9448 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9452 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9453 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9454 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9455 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9457 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9458 areas in HTML export}).
9460 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9461 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9462 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9467 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9468 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9469 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9470 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9471 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9472 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9473 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9474 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9475 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9476 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9477 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9478 will create a new fixed-width region.
9481 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9482 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9483 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9484 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9485 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9489 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9490 @section Include files
9491 @cindex include files, markup rules
9493 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9494 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9498 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9502 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9503 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9504 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9505 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9506 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9507 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9508 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9509 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9510 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9514 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9517 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9518 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9519 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9523 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9524 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9525 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9531 Visit the include file at point.
9534 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9535 @section Index entries
9536 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9538 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9539 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9540 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9541 an index} for more information.
9546 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9552 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9553 @section Macro replacement
9554 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9557 You can define text snippets with
9560 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9563 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9564 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9565 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9566 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9567 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9568 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9569 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9570 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9571 @code{format-time-string}.
9573 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9574 construct complex HTML code.
9577 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9578 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9579 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9580 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9582 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9583 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9584 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9585 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9586 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9587 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9588 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9589 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9590 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9593 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9594 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9595 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9596 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9597 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9600 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9601 @subsection Special symbols
9602 @cindex math symbols
9603 @cindex special symbols
9604 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9605 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9606 @cindex HTML entities
9607 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9609 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9610 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9611 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9612 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9613 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9614 delimiters, for example:
9617 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9620 @vindex org-entities
9621 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9622 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9623 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9624 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9625 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9626 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9628 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9629 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9630 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9631 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9632 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9634 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9635 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9636 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9637 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9642 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9643 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9644 for display purposes only.
9647 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9648 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9652 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9653 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9654 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9655 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9656 with curly braces. For example
9659 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9660 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9663 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9664 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9665 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9666 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9667 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9668 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9669 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9675 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9676 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9681 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9682 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9685 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9686 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9687 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9689 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9690 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9691 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9692 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9693 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9694 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9695 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9696 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9697 @file{MathJax} on your own
9698 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9699 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9700 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9701 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9702 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9703 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9704 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9705 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9708 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9709 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9712 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9713 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9714 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9715 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9716 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9718 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9719 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9720 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9721 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9722 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9723 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9724 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9727 @noindent For example:
9730 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9731 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9732 \end@{equation@} % etc
9734 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9735 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9739 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9740 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9741 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9742 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9744 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9745 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9746 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9747 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9748 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9752 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9753 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9754 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9755 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9758 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9759 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9760 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9762 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9763 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9768 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9769 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9770 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9771 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9772 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9773 process the entire buffer.
9776 Remove the overlay preview images.
9779 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9780 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9781 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9782 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9785 @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview
9786 You can turn on the previewing of all @LaTeX{} fragments in a file with
9789 #+STARTUP: latexpreview
9792 To disable it, simply use
9795 #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview
9798 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9799 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9802 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9803 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9804 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9805 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9806 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9807 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9808 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9809 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9810 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9814 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9817 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9818 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9822 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9825 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9826 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9827 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9828 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9829 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9830 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9831 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9832 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9833 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9834 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9835 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9839 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9840 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9841 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9842 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9843 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9844 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9847 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9848 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9849 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9852 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9853 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9854 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9855 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9859 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9863 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9864 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9865 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9866 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9867 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9868 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9869 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9870 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9871 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9872 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9873 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9874 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9875 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9876 these different formats.
9878 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9879 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9882 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9883 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9884 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9885 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9886 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9887 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9888 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9889 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9890 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9891 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9892 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9893 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9896 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9897 @section Selective export
9898 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9900 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9901 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9902 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9903 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9904 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9905 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9906 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9910 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9911 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9912 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9913 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9916 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9920 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9921 be removed from the export buffer.
9924 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9925 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9926 variable for more information.
9928 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9929 @section Export options
9930 @cindex options, for export
9932 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9933 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9934 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9935 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9936 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9937 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9938 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9939 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9940 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9941 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9944 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9945 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9952 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9960 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9961 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9963 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9964 @vindex user-full-name
9965 @vindex user-mail-address
9966 @vindex org-export-default-language
9967 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9969 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9970 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9971 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9972 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9973 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9974 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9975 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9976 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9977 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9978 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9979 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9980 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9981 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9982 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9983 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9984 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9985 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9986 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9990 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9991 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9992 settings. Here you can:
9993 @cindex headline levels
9994 @cindex section-numbers
9995 @cindex table of contents
9996 @cindex line-break preservation
9997 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9998 @cindex fixed-width sections
10000 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
10002 @cindex special strings
10003 @cindex emphasized text
10004 @cindex @TeX{} macros
10005 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
10006 @cindex author info, in export
10007 @cindex time info, in export
10008 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
10009 @vindex org-export-author-info
10010 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10011 @vindex org-export-email-info
10012 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10014 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
10015 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
10016 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
10017 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
10018 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
10019 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
10020 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
10021 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
10022 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
10023 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
10024 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
10025 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
10026 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
10027 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
10028 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
10029 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
10030 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
10031 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
10032 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
10033 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
10034 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
10035 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
10036 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
10037 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
10038 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
10039 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
10040 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
10043 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
10044 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
10045 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
10047 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
10048 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
10049 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
10050 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
10052 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
10053 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
10054 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
10055 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
10056 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
10058 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
10059 @section The export dispatcher
10060 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
10062 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
10063 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
10064 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
10065 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
10066 the subtrees are exported.
10069 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
10070 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
10071 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
10072 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
10073 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
10074 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
10075 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
10076 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
10077 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
10078 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
10079 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
10080 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
10081 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
10082 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
10083 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
10084 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
10087 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
10088 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
10089 @cindex ASCII export
10090 @cindex Latin-1 export
10091 @cindex UTF-8 export
10093 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
10094 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
10095 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
10097 @cindex region, active
10098 @cindex active region
10099 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10101 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
10102 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10103 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
10104 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
10105 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10106 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10107 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10108 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
10109 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
10110 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10112 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10113 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10114 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10115 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10116 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10117 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10118 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10119 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10120 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10121 Export only the visible part of the document.
10124 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10125 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10126 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10127 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10128 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10131 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10135 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10136 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10137 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10138 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10139 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10140 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10141 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10143 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10144 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10145 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10146 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10148 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10149 @section HTML export
10150 @cindex HTML export
10152 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10153 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10154 language, but with additional support for tables.
10157 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10158 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10159 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10160 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10161 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10162 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10163 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10164 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10165 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10166 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10169 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10170 @subsection HTML export commands
10172 @cindex region, active
10173 @cindex active region
10174 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10176 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10177 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10178 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10179 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10180 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10181 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10182 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10183 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10184 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10185 property, that name will be used for the export.
10186 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10187 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10188 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10189 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10190 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10191 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10192 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10193 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10194 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10195 Export only the visible part of the document.
10196 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10197 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10198 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10200 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10201 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10205 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10206 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10207 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10208 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10209 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10212 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10216 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10219 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10220 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10221 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10222 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10223 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10224 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10225 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10226 @vindex org-export-author-info
10227 @vindex org-export-email-info
10228 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10229 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10231 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10233 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10234 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10235 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10237 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10238 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10239 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10240 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10241 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10242 insert any preamble.
10244 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10245 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10246 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10247 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10248 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10249 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10250 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10251 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10252 insert any postamble.
10254 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10255 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10257 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
10258 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10259 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10260 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10261 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10262 the exported file use either
10265 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10267 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10271 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10275 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10280 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10281 @subsection Links in HTML export
10283 @cindex links, in HTML export
10284 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10285 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10286 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10287 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10288 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10289 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10290 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10291 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10292 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10293 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10294 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10296 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10297 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10298 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10299 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10301 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10303 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10304 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10307 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10309 @cindex tables, in HTML
10310 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10312 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10313 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10314 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10315 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10318 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10320 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10321 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10324 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10325 @subsection Images in HTML export
10327 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10328 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10329 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10330 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10331 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10332 default@footnote{But see the variable
10333 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10334 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10335 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10336 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10337 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10338 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10339 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10340 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10343 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10346 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10347 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10348 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10351 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10353 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10354 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10359 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10361 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10362 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10366 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10367 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10368 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10369 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10370 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10371 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10372 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10373 found on the MathJax website, see
10374 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10375 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10376 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10377 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10380 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10383 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10384 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10387 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10388 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10389 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10390 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10391 You can still get this processing with
10394 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10397 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10398 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10400 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10401 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10402 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10403 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10404 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10405 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10406 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10407 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10408 respectively. For example
10411 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10412 (defun org-xor (a b)
10419 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10420 @subsection CSS support
10421 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10422 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10424 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10425 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10426 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10427 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10428 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10429 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10430 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10431 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10432 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10434 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10435 p.date @r{publishing date}
10436 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10437 .title @r{document title}
10438 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10439 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10440 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10441 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10442 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10443 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10444 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10445 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10446 .target @r{target for links}
10447 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10448 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10449 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10450 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10451 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10452 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10453 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10454 pre.example @r{normal example}
10455 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10456 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10457 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10458 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10459 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10462 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10463 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10464 @vindex org-export-html-style
10465 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10466 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10467 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10468 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10469 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10470 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10471 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10472 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10473 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10474 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10475 individually for each file, you can use
10479 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10483 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10484 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10485 referring to an external file.
10487 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10488 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10489 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10492 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10493 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10495 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10496 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10498 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10499 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10500 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10501 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10502 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10503 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10504 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10505 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10506 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10507 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10508 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10509 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10510 copy on your own web server.
10512 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10513 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10514 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10515 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10516 adding a single line to the Org file:
10518 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10520 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10524 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10525 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10529 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10530 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10531 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10532 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10533 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10534 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10535 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10536 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10537 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10538 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10539 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10540 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10541 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10542 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10543 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10544 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10545 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10546 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10547 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10548 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10549 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10550 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10551 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10552 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10553 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10556 @vindex org-infojs-options
10557 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10558 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10559 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10560 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10562 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10563 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10564 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10566 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10568 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10569 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10570 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10571 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10572 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10573 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10574 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10575 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10576 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10577 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10581 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10582 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10583 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10584 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10585 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10586 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10589 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10590 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10592 @cindex region, active
10593 @cindex active region
10594 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10596 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10597 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10598 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10599 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10600 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10601 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10602 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10603 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10604 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10605 property, that name will be used for the export.
10606 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10607 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10608 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10609 Export only the visible part of the document.
10610 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10611 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10612 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10614 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10615 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10617 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10618 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10619 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10620 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10623 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10624 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10625 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10626 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10627 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10628 convert them to a custom string depending on
10629 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10631 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10632 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10635 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10639 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10641 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10642 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10643 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10644 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10645 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10646 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10647 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10649 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10651 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10652 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10653 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10654 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10655 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10656 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10657 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10658 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10659 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10660 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10661 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10662 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10663 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10664 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10665 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10666 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10667 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10668 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10669 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10670 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10671 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10672 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10673 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10674 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10678 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10679 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10680 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10686 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10687 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10689 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10690 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10691 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10692 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10693 the following constructs:
10696 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10698 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10702 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10706 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10711 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10712 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10713 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10715 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10716 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10717 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10718 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10719 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10720 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10721 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10726 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10728 #+CAPTION: A long table
10730 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10735 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10739 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10741 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10743 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10748 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10749 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10750 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10751 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10753 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10754 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10755 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10756 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10757 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10758 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10759 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10760 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10761 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10762 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10763 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10764 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10765 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10766 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10767 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10768 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10770 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10771 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10772 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10773 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10774 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10775 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10779 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10781 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10782 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10783 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10784 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10786 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10790 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10791 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10792 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10794 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10795 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10797 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10798 @subsection Beamer class export
10800 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10801 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10802 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10804 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10805 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10806 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10807 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10808 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10809 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10810 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10811 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10812 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10813 structure of the presentation.
10815 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10816 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10817 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10818 editing special properties used by beamer.
10820 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10825 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10826 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10827 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10828 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10829 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10830 @item BEAMER_envargs
10831 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10832 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10833 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10834 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10835 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10838 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10839 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10840 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10841 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10842 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10843 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10844 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10845 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10847 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10848 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10852 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10853 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10854 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10855 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10856 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10857 in the presentation as well.
10859 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10860 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10861 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10862 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10863 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10864 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10865 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10867 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10875 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10876 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10877 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10880 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10881 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10882 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10883 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10885 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10888 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10889 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10890 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10891 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10892 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10893 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10894 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10896 * This is the first structural section
10898 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10899 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10902 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10905 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10906 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10910 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10912 for contributing to the discussion
10913 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10914 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10915 *** Request :B_block:
10916 Please test this stuff!
10922 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10924 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10925 @section DocBook export
10926 @cindex DocBook export
10928 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10930 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10931 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10932 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10933 tools and stylesheets.
10935 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10938 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10939 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10940 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10941 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10942 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10943 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10946 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10947 @subsection DocBook export commands
10949 @cindex region, active
10950 @cindex active region
10951 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10953 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10954 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10955 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10956 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10957 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10958 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10959 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10960 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10961 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10962 property, that name will be used for the export.
10963 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10964 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10966 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10967 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10968 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10969 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10970 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10971 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10973 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10974 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10975 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10976 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10977 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10978 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10980 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10981 Export only the visible part of the document.
10984 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10985 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10987 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10988 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10991 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10993 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10997 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
11001 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
11006 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
11007 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
11008 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
11009 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
11014 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
11015 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
11016 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
11021 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
11022 @subsection Recursive sections
11023 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
11025 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
11026 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
11027 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
11028 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
11029 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
11030 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
11032 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
11033 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
11035 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
11036 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
11037 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11039 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
11042 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
11043 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
11044 using the @code{table} element.
11046 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
11047 @subsection Images in DocBook export
11048 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
11049 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
11051 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
11052 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
11053 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
11054 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
11055 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
11056 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
11057 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
11058 @code{mediaobject} element.
11060 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
11061 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
11062 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
11063 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
11064 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
11065 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
11066 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
11067 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
11069 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
11070 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
11071 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
11072 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
11073 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
11078 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
11080 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
11081 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
11082 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
11083 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
11086 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
11087 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
11088 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
11089 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
11090 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
11092 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
11093 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
11094 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
11096 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
11097 @vindex org-entities
11098 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
11099 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
11100 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
11101 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
11102 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
11103 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
11105 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
11106 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
11107 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
11108 special characters included in XHTML entities:
11111 "<!DOCTYPE article [
11112 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11113 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11114 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11121 @c begin opendocument
11123 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11124 @section OpenDocument Text export
11125 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11127 @cindex OpenDocument
11128 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11129 @cindex LibreOffice
11131 @cindex org-modules
11133 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11134 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11135 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11136 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11137 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11138 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11141 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11142 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11143 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11144 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11145 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11146 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11147 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11148 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11149 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11150 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11151 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11154 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11155 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11157 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11158 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11160 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11161 @subsection ODT export commands
11163 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11164 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11166 @cindex region, active
11167 @cindex active region
11168 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11170 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11171 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11173 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11175 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11176 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11177 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11178 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11180 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11181 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11182 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11183 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11184 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11185 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11186 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11189 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11190 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11192 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11193 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11194 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11195 exporting to other formats}.
11198 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11199 @subsection Extending ODT export
11201 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11202 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11203 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11204 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11206 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11207 @cindex LibreOffice
11208 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11209 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11210 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11211 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11212 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11213 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11214 document converter}.
11216 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11217 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11219 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11220 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11221 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11222 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11223 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11224 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11225 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11226 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11228 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11229 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11231 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11232 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11233 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11234 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11235 the following command.
11237 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11240 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11241 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11242 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11245 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11246 @subsection Applying custom styles
11247 @cindex styles, custom
11248 @cindex template, custom
11250 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11251 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11252 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11253 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11254 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11255 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11256 users alike, and is described here.
11258 @subsubsection Applying custom styles: the easy way
11262 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11266 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11270 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11271 to locate the target styles---these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix---and
11272 modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11273 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11276 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11277 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11278 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11279 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11280 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11282 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11283 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11286 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11292 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11297 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11299 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11300 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11301 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11302 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11303 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11304 the factory settings.
11306 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11307 @subsection Links in ODT export
11308 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11310 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11311 Internet-style links for all other links.
11313 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11314 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11316 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11317 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11318 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11320 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11321 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11322 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11324 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11325 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables---tables
11326 that have column or row spans---is not supported. Such tables are
11327 stripped from the exported document.
11329 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11330 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11331 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11332 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11333 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11334 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11337 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11338 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11340 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11344 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11345 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11346 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11348 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11349 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11350 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11351 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11352 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11353 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11356 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11357 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11358 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11359 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11360 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11362 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11363 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11364 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11366 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11367 @subsection Images in ODT export
11368 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11369 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11371 @subsubheading Embedding images
11372 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11373 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11374 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11384 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11385 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11386 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11387 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11388 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11391 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11394 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11397 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11398 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11400 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11401 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11402 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11403 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11404 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11405 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11406 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11407 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11408 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11409 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11410 converted in to units of centimeters using
11411 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11412 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11413 achieve the best results.
11415 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11418 @item Explicitly size the image
11419 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11422 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11426 @item Scale the image
11427 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11430 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11434 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11435 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11436 height:width ratio, do the following:
11439 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11443 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11444 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11445 height:width ratio, do the following
11448 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11453 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11456 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11457 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11458 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property:
11459 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11461 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11463 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11467 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11468 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11470 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11473 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11474 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11477 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11478 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11480 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11481 document in one of the following ways:
11487 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11493 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11494 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11495 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11496 the exported document.
11498 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11499 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11501 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11502 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11503 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11505 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11506 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11507 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11510 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11511 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11512 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11513 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11516 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11517 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11521 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11522 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11524 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11525 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11526 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11532 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11535 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11538 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11539 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11540 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11543 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11544 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11546 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11547 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11548 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11549 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11561 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11562 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11564 You can label and caption various category of objects---an inline image, a
11565 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula---using @code{#+LABEL} and
11566 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11567 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11568 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11569 appearance in the Org file.
11571 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11572 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11576 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11577 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11581 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11584 Figure 2: Bell curve
11587 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11588 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11589 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11590 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11591 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11594 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11595 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11598 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11602 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11605 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11606 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11608 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11609 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11610 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11611 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11612 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11613 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11614 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11616 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11617 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11618 by customizing the variable
11619 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11621 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11622 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11623 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11625 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11626 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11628 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11629 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11630 that would be of interest to power users.
11633 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11634 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11635 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11636 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11637 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11640 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11641 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11643 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11646 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11647 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11648 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11649 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11652 @item Register the converter
11654 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11655 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11656 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11657 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11659 @item Configure its capabilities
11661 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11662 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11663 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11664 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11665 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11666 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11667 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11668 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11670 @item Choose the converter
11672 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11673 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11674 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11677 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11678 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11679 @cindex styles, custom
11680 @cindex template, custom
11682 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11683 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11684 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11687 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11688 @subsubheading Factory styles
11690 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11691 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11692 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11695 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11697 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11699 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11700 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11704 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11707 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11711 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11713 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11715 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11716 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11717 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11719 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11720 file serves the following purposes:
11724 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11728 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11729 elements that control how various entities---tables, images, equations,
11730 etc.---are numbered.
11734 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11735 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11736 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11737 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11738 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11742 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11744 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11746 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11747 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11750 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11752 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11754 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11756 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11759 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11761 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11762 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11763 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11765 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11766 like header and footer images.
11770 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11773 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11775 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11777 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11778 in the final output.
11781 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11782 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11784 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11785 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11786 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11789 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11791 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11792 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11795 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11796 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11800 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11801 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11802 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11805 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11806 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11810 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11812 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11813 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11816 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11819 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11820 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11821 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11824 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11825 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11826 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11830 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11832 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11833 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11835 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11840 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11841 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11848 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11849 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11850 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11853 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11854 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11855 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11857 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11859 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11860 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11864 @subsubheading Custom table styles: an illustration
11866 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11867 the table that follows.
11870 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11871 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11872 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11873 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11874 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11875 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11876 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11877 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11881 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11882 | Name | Phone | Age |
11883 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11884 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11887 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11888 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11889 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11890 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11891 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11892 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11893 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11894 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11896 @subsubheading Custom table styles: the nitty-gritty
11897 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11901 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11902 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11904 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11905 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11919 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11920 template using a well-defined convention.
11922 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11923 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11924 the following table.
11926 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11927 @headitem Table cell type
11928 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11929 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11934 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11935 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11937 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11938 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11940 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11941 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11943 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11944 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11946 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11947 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11949 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11950 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11952 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11953 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11955 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11956 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11958 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11959 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11962 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11964 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11965 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11969 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11970 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11971 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11972 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11973 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11974 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11976 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11977 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11978 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11981 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11982 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11985 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11986 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11987 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11988 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11991 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11992 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11993 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11994 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11995 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11996 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11997 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11998 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
12002 Associate a table with the table style
12004 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
12005 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
12008 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
12009 | Name | Phone | Age |
12010 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
12011 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
12015 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
12016 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
12018 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
12019 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
12020 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
12021 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
12022 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
12024 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
12025 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
12026 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
12027 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
12029 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
12030 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
12031 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
12032 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
12033 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
12034 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
12036 @c end opendocument
12038 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
12039 @section TaskJuggler export
12040 @cindex TaskJuggler export
12041 @cindex Project management
12043 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
12044 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
12045 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
12048 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
12049 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
12050 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
12053 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
12054 optionally trees that define the resources and reports for this project.
12055 It then creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes
12056 defined in all the nodes.
12058 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
12061 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
12062 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
12064 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
12065 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI (only
12066 for TaskJugglerUI 2.x).
12071 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
12072 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
12073 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
12074 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
12075 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
12076 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
12077 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
12078 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
12079 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
12080 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
12082 @subsection Resources
12084 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
12085 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
12086 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
12087 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
12088 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
12089 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
12090 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
12091 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
12092 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
12093 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
12094 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
12095 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
12096 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
12098 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
12099 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
12102 @subsection Export of properties
12104 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if
12105 a task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
12106 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Scheduling information is also taken into
12107 account to set start/end dates for tasks.
12109 The exporter will also export any property on a task resource or resource
12110 node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation},
12111 @samp{shift}, @samp{booking}, @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry},
12112 @samp{rate} for resources or @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note},
12113 @samp{duration}, @samp{end}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone},
12114 @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible}, @samp{scheduling}, etc.@: for tasks.
12116 @subsection Dependencies
12118 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12119 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12120 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12121 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12122 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12123 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12124 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12125 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12126 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12127 examples should illustrate this:
12132 :task_id: preparation
12135 * Training material
12137 :task_id: training_material
12140 ** Markup Guidelines
12144 ** Workflow Guidelines
12151 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12155 @subsection Reports
12157 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12158 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12159 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12160 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. By default, the exporter will
12161 automatically insert some pre-set reports in the file. These defaults are
12162 defined in @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be
12163 modified using customize along with a number of other options. For a more
12164 complete list, see @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler
12167 Alternately, the user can tag a tree with
12168 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-report-tag}, and define reports in sub-nodes,
12169 similarly to what is done with tasks or resources. The properties used for
12170 report generation are defined in
12171 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-valid-report-attributes}. In addition, a special
12172 property named @samp{report-kind} is used to define the kind of report one
12173 wants to generate (by default, a @samp{taskreport}).
12175 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12176 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12178 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12179 @section Freemind export
12180 @cindex Freemind export
12183 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12186 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12187 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12188 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12191 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12192 @section XOXO export
12193 @cindex XOXO export
12195 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12196 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12197 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12200 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12201 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12202 @file{myfile.html}.
12203 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12204 Export only the visible part of the document.
12207 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12208 @section iCalendar export
12209 @cindex iCalendar export
12211 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12212 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12213 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12214 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12215 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12216 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12217 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12218 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12219 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12220 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12221 included in the export, configure the variable
12222 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12223 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12224 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12225 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12226 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12227 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12228 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12229 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12230 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12233 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12234 @cindex property, ID
12235 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12236 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12237 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12238 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12239 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12240 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12241 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12242 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12243 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12246 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12247 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12248 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12249 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12250 @vindex org-agenda-files
12251 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12252 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12253 file will be written.
12254 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12255 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12256 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12257 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12258 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12261 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12262 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12263 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12264 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12265 @cindex property, LOCATION
12266 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12267 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12268 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12269 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12270 and the description from the body (limited to
12271 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12273 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12274 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12276 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12277 @chapter Publishing
12280 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12281 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12282 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12283 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12286 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12287 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12289 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12292 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12293 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12294 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12295 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12298 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12299 @section Configuration
12301 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12302 and many other properties of a project.
12305 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12306 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12307 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12308 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12309 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12310 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12311 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12312 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12315 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12316 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12317 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12318 @cindex projects, for publishing
12320 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12321 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12322 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12323 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12326 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12327 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12329 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12333 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12334 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12335 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12336 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12337 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12338 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12339 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12342 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12343 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12344 @cindex directories, for publishing
12346 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12347 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12348 and where to put published files.
12350 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12351 @item @code{:base-directory}
12352 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12353 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12354 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12355 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12356 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12357 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12358 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12359 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12360 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12361 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12362 variable @code{project-plist}.
12363 @item @code{:completion-function}
12364 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12365 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12366 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12367 @code{project-plist}.
12371 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12372 @subsection Selecting files
12373 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12375 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12376 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12378 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12379 @item @code{:base-extension}
12380 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12381 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12382 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12384 @item @code{:exclude}
12385 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12386 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12389 @item @code{:include}
12390 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12391 and @code{:exclude}.
12393 @item @code{:recursive}
12394 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12397 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12398 @subsection Publishing action
12399 @cindex action, for publishing
12401 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12402 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12403 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12404 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12405 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12406 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12407 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12408 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12409 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12410 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12411 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12412 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12413 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12414 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12415 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12416 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12417 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12418 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12419 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12421 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12422 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12423 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12424 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12425 @item @code{:plain-source}
12426 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12427 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12428 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12431 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12432 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12433 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12434 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12435 and place the result into the destination folder.
12437 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12438 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12439 @cindex options, for publishing
12441 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12442 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12443 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12444 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12445 respective variable for details.
12447 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12448 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12449 @vindex org-export-default-language
12450 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12451 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12452 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12453 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12454 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12455 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12456 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12457 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12458 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12459 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12460 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12461 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12462 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12463 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12464 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12465 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12466 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12467 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12468 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12469 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12470 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12471 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12472 @vindex org-export-author-info
12473 @vindex org-export-email-info
12474 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12475 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12476 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12477 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12478 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12479 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12480 @vindex org-export-html-style
12481 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12482 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12483 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12484 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12485 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12486 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12487 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12488 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12489 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12490 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12491 @vindex user-full-name
12492 @vindex user-mail-address
12493 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12494 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12496 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12497 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12498 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12499 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12500 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12501 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12502 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12503 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12504 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12505 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12506 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12507 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12508 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12509 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12510 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12511 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12512 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12513 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12514 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12515 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12516 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12517 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12518 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12519 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12520 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12521 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12522 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12523 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12524 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12525 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12526 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12527 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12528 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12529 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12530 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12531 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12532 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12533 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12534 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12535 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12536 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12537 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12538 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12539 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12540 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12541 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12542 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12543 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12544 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12545 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12548 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12549 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12550 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12551 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12556 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12557 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12558 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12559 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12560 options}), however, override everything.
12562 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12563 @subsection Links between published files
12564 @cindex links, publishing
12566 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12567 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12568 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12569 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12570 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12571 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12572 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12573 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12576 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12577 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12578 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12579 an example of this usage.
12581 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12582 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12583 location. In this case, use the property
12585 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12586 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12587 @tab Function to validate links
12591 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12592 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12593 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12594 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12595 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12596 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12597 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12599 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12600 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12601 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12603 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12604 a map of files for a given project.
12606 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12607 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12608 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12609 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12611 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12612 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12613 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12615 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12616 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12618 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12619 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12620 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12621 of links to all files in the project.
12623 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12624 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12625 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12626 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12628 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12629 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12630 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12631 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12632 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12633 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12634 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12636 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12637 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12639 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12640 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12641 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12642 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12643 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12644 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12645 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12647 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12648 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12649 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12650 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12652 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12653 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12654 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12655 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12659 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12660 @subsection Generating an index
12661 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12663 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12665 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12666 @item @code{:makeindex}
12667 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12668 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12671 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12672 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12673 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12674 a title, style information, etc.
12676 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12677 @section Uploading files
12681 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12682 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12683 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12684 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12685 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12688 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12689 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12690 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12691 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12692 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12694 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12695 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12696 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12697 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12698 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12699 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12702 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12703 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12704 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12705 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12706 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12707 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12709 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12710 @section Sample configuration
12712 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12713 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12714 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12717 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12718 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12721 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12722 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12724 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12725 directory on the local machine.
12728 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12730 :base-directory "~/org/"
12731 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12732 :section-numbers nil
12733 :table-of-contents nil
12734 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12735 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12736 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12739 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12740 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12742 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12743 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12744 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12747 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12748 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12749 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12750 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12753 file:../images/myimage.png
12756 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12757 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12758 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12761 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12763 :base-directory "~/org/"
12764 :base-extension "org"
12765 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12766 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12767 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12769 :section-numbers nil
12770 :table-of-contents nil
12771 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12772 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12776 :base-directory "~/images/"
12777 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12778 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12779 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12782 :base-directory "~/other/"
12783 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12784 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12785 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12786 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12789 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12790 @section Triggering publication
12792 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12795 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12796 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12797 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12798 Publish the project containing the current file.
12799 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12800 Publish only the current file.
12801 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12802 Publish every project.
12805 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12806 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12807 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12808 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12809 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12810 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12811 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12813 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12814 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12816 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12817 @chapter Working with source code
12818 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12819 @cindex Davison, Dan
12820 @cindex source code, working with
12822 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12826 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12827 (defun org-xor (a b)
12833 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12834 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12835 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12836 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12837 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12838 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12840 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12843 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12844 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12845 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12846 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12847 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12848 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12849 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12850 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12851 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12852 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12853 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12854 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12857 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12858 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12860 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12861 @section Structure of code blocks
12862 @cindex code block, structure
12863 @cindex source code, block structure
12865 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12867 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12868 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12869 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12873 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12878 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12879 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12880 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12881 @cindex source code, inline
12883 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12886 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12892 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12896 @item <#+NAME: name>
12897 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12898 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12899 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12900 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12901 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12902 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12906 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12907 @cindex source code, language
12909 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12910 @ref{Literal examples})
12911 @cindex source code, switches
12912 @item <header arguments>
12913 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12914 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12915 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12916 basis using properties.
12917 @item source code, header arguments
12919 Source code in the specified language.
12922 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12923 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12925 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12926 @section Editing source code
12927 @cindex code block, editing
12928 @cindex source code, editing
12931 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12932 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12933 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12934 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12936 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12937 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12938 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12939 further configuration options.
12942 @item org-src-lang-modes
12943 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12944 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12945 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12946 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12947 @item org-src-window-setup
12948 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12949 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12950 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12951 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12952 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12953 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12954 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12957 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12958 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12960 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12961 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12963 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12964 @section Exporting code blocks
12965 @cindex code block, exporting
12966 @cindex source code, exporting
12968 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12969 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12970 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12971 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12972 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12973 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12975 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12978 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12980 @item :exports code
12981 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12982 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12983 @item :exports results
12984 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12985 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12986 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12987 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12988 block will not be exported.
12989 @item :exports both
12990 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12991 @item :exports none
12992 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12995 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12996 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12997 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12998 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12999 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
13000 markup language for a wiki.
13002 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13003 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
13004 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
13005 @section Extracting source code
13007 @cindex source code, extracting
13008 @cindex code block, extracting source code
13010 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
13011 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
13012 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
13013 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
13014 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
13016 @subsubheading Header arguments
13019 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
13021 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
13022 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
13023 for the block language.
13024 @item :tangle filename
13025 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
13029 @subsubheading Functions
13031 @item org-babel-tangle
13032 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
13034 With prefix argument only tangle the current code block.
13035 @item org-babel-tangle-file
13036 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
13039 @subsubheading Hooks
13041 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
13042 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
13043 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
13044 of tangled code files.
13047 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
13048 @section Evaluating code blocks
13049 @cindex code block, evaluating
13050 @cindex source code, evaluating
13053 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
13054 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
13055 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
13056 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
13057 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
13058 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
13059 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
13060 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
13061 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
13062 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
13064 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
13065 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
13066 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
13067 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
13068 used to define a code block).
13071 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
13072 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
13073 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
13074 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
13075 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
13076 its results into the Org mode buffer.
13079 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
13080 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
13081 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
13082 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
13083 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
13085 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
13088 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
13089 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
13092 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
13095 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
13096 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
13101 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
13103 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
13104 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
13105 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
13106 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
13107 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
13108 @item <inside header arguments>
13109 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
13110 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
13111 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
13112 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
13113 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
13114 @item <end header arguments>
13115 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
13116 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
13117 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
13118 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
13119 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
13121 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13122 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13125 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13126 @section Library of Babel
13127 @cindex babel, library of
13128 @cindex source code, library
13129 @cindex code block, library
13131 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13132 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13133 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13134 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13137 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13138 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13140 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13141 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13142 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13146 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13147 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13150 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13152 @cindex babel, languages
13153 @cindex source code, languages
13154 @cindex code block, languages
13156 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13158 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13159 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13160 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13161 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13162 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13163 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13164 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13165 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13166 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13167 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13168 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13169 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13170 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13171 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13172 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13173 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13174 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13175 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13176 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13177 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13180 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13181 available, it can be found at
13182 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13184 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13185 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13186 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13187 to your emacs configuration.
13190 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13191 @code{R} code blocks.
13195 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13196 'org-babel-load-languages
13197 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13201 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13202 elisp file with @code{require}.
13205 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13209 (require 'ob-clojure)
13212 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13213 @section Header arguments
13214 @cindex code block, header arguments
13215 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13217 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13218 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13219 describes each header argument in detail.
13222 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13223 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13226 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13227 @subsection Using header arguments
13229 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13230 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13232 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13233 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13234 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13235 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13236 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13237 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13241 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13242 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13243 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13244 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13245 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13249 :results => "replace"
13256 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13258 @c ((:session . "none")
13259 @c (:results . "replace")
13260 @c (:exports . "code")
13262 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13266 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13269 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13270 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13271 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13275 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13276 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13277 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13280 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13281 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13282 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13283 language-specific documentation available online at
13284 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13286 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13287 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13288 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13289 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13290 @ref{Property syntax}).
13292 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13293 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13294 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13295 inserted into the buffer.
13298 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13299 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13302 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13303 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13305 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13306 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13307 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13310 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13313 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13314 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13315 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13316 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13317 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13318 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13328 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13329 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13330 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13331 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13332 in Org mode documents.
13334 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13335 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13337 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13338 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13339 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13340 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13341 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13342 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13343 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13344 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13345 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13346 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13350 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13352 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13355 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13358 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13361 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13362 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13363 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13367 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13370 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13371 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13372 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13379 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13382 #+NAME: named-block
13383 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13384 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13385 (message "data:%S" data)
13388 #+RESULTS: named-block
13392 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13393 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13394 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13396 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13397 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13398 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13401 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13402 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13405 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13408 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13409 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13412 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13415 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13416 @subsection Specific header arguments
13417 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13418 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13421 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13422 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13423 be collected and handled
13424 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13425 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13426 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13427 directory for code block execution
13428 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13429 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13430 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13431 files during tangling
13432 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13434 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13436 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13437 expansion during tangling
13438 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13439 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13440 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13441 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13442 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13443 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13444 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13445 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13446 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13447 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13448 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13449 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13452 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13455 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13456 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13457 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13458 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13459 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13460 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13461 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13463 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13464 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13465 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13466 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13467 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13470 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13471 Indexable variable values}).
13473 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13474 @code{:var} header argument.
13480 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13481 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13482 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13483 results of evaluating another code block.
13485 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13490 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13493 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13499 #+NAME: table-length
13500 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13504 #+RESULTS: table-length
13509 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13510 carried through to the source code block)
13513 #+NAME: example-list
13519 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13527 @item code block without arguments
13528 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13529 optionally followed by parentheses
13532 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13540 @item code block with arguments
13541 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13542 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13543 code block name using standard function call syntax
13547 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13555 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13563 @item literal example
13564 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13567 #+NAME: literal-example
13573 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13574 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13575 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13578 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13579 : A literal example
13580 : on two lines for you.
13586 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13587 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13588 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13589 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13590 following the source name.
13593 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13594 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13599 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13600 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13601 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13602 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13603 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13604 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13605 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13606 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13607 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13610 #+NAME: example-table
13616 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13624 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13625 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13626 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13630 #+NAME: example-table
13637 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13647 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13648 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13649 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13650 column is referenced.
13653 #+NAME: example-table
13659 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13667 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13668 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13669 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13673 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13674 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13675 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13676 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13679 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13687 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13689 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13690 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13691 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13692 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13693 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13694 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13695 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13696 evaluation of the code block body.
13699 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13704 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13705 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13711 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13720 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13721 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13723 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13724 per class may be supplied per code block.
13728 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13729 from the code block
13731 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13732 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13735 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13736 block should be handled.
13739 @subsubheading Collection
13740 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13741 should be collected from the code block.
13745 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13746 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13747 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13748 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13749 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13750 @item @code{output}
13751 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13752 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13753 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13756 @subsubheading Type
13758 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13759 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13760 table or scalar depending on their value.
13763 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13764 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13765 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13766 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13768 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13769 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13770 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13771 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13772 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13773 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13775 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13776 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13778 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13779 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13780 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13782 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13783 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13784 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13786 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13787 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13789 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13790 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13792 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13793 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13795 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13796 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13797 @code{:results value pp}.
13798 @item @code{drawer}
13799 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13800 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13801 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13804 @subsubheading Handling
13805 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13806 results once they are collected.
13809 @item @code{silent}
13810 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13811 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13812 @item @code{replace}
13813 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13814 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13815 @code{:results output replace}.
13816 @item @code{append}
13817 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13818 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13819 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13820 @item @code{prepend}
13821 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13822 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13823 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13826 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13827 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13829 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13830 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13831 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13832 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13833 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13834 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13835 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13836 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13838 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13839 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13840 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13842 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13843 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13845 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13846 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13847 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13848 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13849 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13851 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13852 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13854 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13855 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13856 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13857 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13858 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13859 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13860 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13862 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13863 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13864 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13866 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13867 in your home directory, you could use
13870 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13871 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13875 @subsubheading Remote execution
13876 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13877 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13880 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13881 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13885 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13886 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13887 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13890 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13891 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13894 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13897 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13898 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13899 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13900 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13902 @subsubheading Further points
13906 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13907 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13908 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13910 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13911 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13912 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13913 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13914 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13915 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13916 which the link does not point.
13919 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13920 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13922 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13923 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13927 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13928 @code{:exports code}.
13929 @item @code{results}
13930 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13931 @code{:exports results}.
13933 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13934 @code{:exports both}.
13936 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13939 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13940 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13942 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13943 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13946 @item @code{tangle}
13947 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13948 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13949 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13951 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13952 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13954 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13955 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13956 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13959 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13960 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13962 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13963 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13964 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13966 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13967 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13968 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13969 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13970 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13971 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13975 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13977 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13978 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13980 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13982 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13984 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13985 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13987 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13989 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13990 references in the code block body in link comments.
13993 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13994 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13995 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13996 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13997 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
14002 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
14004 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
14007 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
14008 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
14010 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14011 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
14012 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
14013 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
14014 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
14016 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
14017 @subsubsection @code{:session}
14019 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
14020 language where state is preserved.
14022 By default, a session is not started.
14024 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
14025 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
14026 interpreted language.
14028 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
14029 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
14031 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
14032 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
14033 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
14034 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
14035 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
14039 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
14040 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
14042 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
14043 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
14044 @item @code{tangle}
14045 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
14046 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
14047 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
14048 @item @code{no-export}
14049 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
14050 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
14051 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
14052 @item @code{strip-export}
14053 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
14054 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
14055 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
14057 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
14058 expanded before the block is evaluated.
14061 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
14062 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
14063 @code{<<reference>>}.
14064 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
14065 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
14066 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
14078 -- multi-line body of example
14081 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
14082 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
14085 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
14086 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
14087 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
14088 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
14089 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
14090 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
14092 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
14093 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
14094 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
14095 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
14096 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
14100 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
14103 * the mount point of the fullest disk
14105 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
14108 ** query all mounted disks
14113 ** strip the header row
14118 ** sort by the percent full
14120 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
14123 ** extract the mount point
14125 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14129 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14130 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14133 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14134 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14136 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14137 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14140 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14141 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14143 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14144 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14145 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14146 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14147 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14148 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14149 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14153 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14154 every time it is called.
14156 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14157 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14158 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14159 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14160 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14163 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14164 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14165 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14166 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14167 changed since it was last run.
14171 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14175 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14179 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14183 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14187 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14188 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14190 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14191 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14192 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14193 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14194 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14197 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14200 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14201 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14203 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14204 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14205 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14209 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14210 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14211 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14212 default value yields the following results. Note that the @code{:hline}
14213 header argument has no effect for Emacs Lisp code blocks.
14216 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14224 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14228 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14235 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14238 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14246 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14250 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14259 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14260 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14262 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14263 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14264 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14265 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14266 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14267 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14271 If an input table looks like it has column names
14272 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14273 names will be removed from the table before
14274 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14277 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14283 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14284 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14285 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14288 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14295 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14296 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14299 No column name pre-processing takes place
14302 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14303 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14307 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14308 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14310 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes} or
14311 @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}. Note that Emacs Lisp code
14312 blocks ignore the @code{:rownames} header argument entirely given the ease
14313 with which tables with row names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14317 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14320 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14321 and is then reapplied to the results.
14324 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14325 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14326 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14328 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14329 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14330 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14333 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14334 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14335 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14338 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14339 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14343 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14344 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14346 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14347 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14348 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14349 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14351 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14352 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14353 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14354 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14355 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14356 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14357 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14358 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14362 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14364 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14365 @item never-export or no-export
14366 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14369 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14372 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14373 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14376 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14377 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14378 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14379 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14380 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14381 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14382 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14384 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14385 @section Results of evaluation
14386 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14387 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14389 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14390 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14391 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14392 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14394 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14395 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14396 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14397 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14400 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14401 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14402 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14404 @subsection Non-session
14405 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14406 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14407 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14408 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14409 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14410 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14411 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14413 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14414 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14416 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14417 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14418 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14419 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14422 @subsection Session
14423 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14424 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14425 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14426 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14427 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14428 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14429 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14430 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14432 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14433 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14434 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14435 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14438 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14439 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14440 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14441 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14442 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14443 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14444 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14447 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14458 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14461 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14473 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14474 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14477 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14478 @section Noweb reference syntax
14479 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14480 @cindex syntax, noweb
14481 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14483 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14484 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14485 familiar Noweb syntax:
14488 <<code-block-name>>
14491 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14492 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14493 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14494 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14495 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14496 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14498 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14499 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14500 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14503 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14506 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14507 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14508 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14509 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14512 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14513 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14514 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14515 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14518 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14519 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14520 @cindex code block, key bindings
14522 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14525 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14528 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14530 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14532 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14534 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14536 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14539 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14541 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14543 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14544 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14546 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14547 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14549 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14550 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14552 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14553 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14555 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14556 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14558 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14559 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14561 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14562 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14564 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14565 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14567 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14568 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14570 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14571 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14573 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14574 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14576 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14577 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14579 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14580 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14582 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14583 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14585 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14586 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14588 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14589 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14591 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14592 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14594 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14595 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14597 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14598 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14600 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14601 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14603 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14604 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14606 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14607 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14610 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14611 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14613 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14614 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14615 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14616 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14617 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14618 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14619 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14620 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14621 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14624 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14625 @section Batch execution
14626 @cindex code block, batch execution
14627 @cindex source code, batch execution
14629 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14630 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14632 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14636 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14638 # tangle files with org-mode
14643 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14645 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14650 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14651 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14652 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14653 (mapc (lambda (file)
14654 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14656 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14659 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14660 @chapter Miscellaneous
14663 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14664 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14665 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14666 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14667 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14668 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14669 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14670 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14671 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14672 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14673 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14677 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14678 @section Completion
14679 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14680 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14681 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14682 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14683 @cindex completion, of tags
14684 @cindex completion, of property keys
14685 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14686 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14687 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14688 @cindex dictionary word completion
14689 @cindex option keyword completion
14690 @cindex tag completion
14691 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14693 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14694 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14695 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14696 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14697 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14699 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14700 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14701 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14704 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14706 Complete word at point
14709 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14711 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14713 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14714 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14716 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14717 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14718 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14719 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14721 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14722 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14725 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14727 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14728 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14729 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14730 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14732 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14733 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14735 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14739 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14740 @section Easy Templates
14741 @cindex template insertion
14742 @cindex insertion, of templates
14744 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14745 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14746 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14747 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14748 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14750 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14751 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14752 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14754 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14756 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14757 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14758 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14759 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14760 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14761 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14762 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14763 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14764 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14765 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14766 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14767 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14768 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14769 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14772 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14773 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14775 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14776 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14777 additional details.
14779 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14780 @section Speed keys
14782 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14783 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14785 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14786 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14787 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14788 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14789 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14790 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14791 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14792 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14794 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14795 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14797 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14798 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14800 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14802 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14803 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14804 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14805 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14806 these precautions intact.
14808 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14809 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14810 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14812 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14815 @item Source code blocks
14816 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14817 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14818 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14819 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14820 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14822 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14823 which take off the default security brakes.
14825 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14826 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14827 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14828 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14829 ask and nil not to ask.
14832 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14836 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14837 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14838 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14841 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14842 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14843 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14846 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14847 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14849 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14850 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14853 @item Formulas in tables
14854 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14855 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14858 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14859 @section Customization
14860 @cindex customization
14861 @cindex options, for customization
14862 @cindex variables, for customization
14864 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14865 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14866 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14867 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14868 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14869 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14870 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14872 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14873 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14874 @cindex in-buffer settings
14875 @cindex special keywords
14877 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14878 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14879 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14880 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14881 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14882 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14883 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14884 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14885 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14887 @vindex org-archive-location
14889 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14890 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14891 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14892 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14893 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14895 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14896 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14897 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14898 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14899 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14900 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14901 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14903 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14904 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14905 @vindex org-table-formula
14906 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14907 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14908 The global version of this variable is
14909 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14910 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14911 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14913 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14914 @vindex org-drawers
14915 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14916 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14917 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14918 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14919 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14920 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14921 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14922 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14923 @vindex org-highest-priority
14924 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14925 @vindex org-default-priority
14926 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14927 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
14928 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14929 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14930 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14931 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14932 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14933 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14934 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14935 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14936 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14937 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14938 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14939 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14940 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14943 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14944 Org file is being visited.
14946 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14947 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14948 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14950 @vindex org-startup-folded
14951 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14952 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14953 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14954 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14956 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14957 content @r{all headlines}
14958 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14959 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14962 @vindex org-startup-indented
14963 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14964 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14965 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14966 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14968 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14969 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14972 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14973 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14974 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14975 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14977 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14978 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14980 align @r{align all tables}
14981 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14984 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14985 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14986 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14987 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14988 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14989 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14991 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14992 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14995 @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview
14996 When visiting a file, @LaTeX{} fragments can be converted to images
14997 automatically. The variable @code{org-startup-with-latex-preview} which
14998 controls this behavior, is set to @code{nil} by default to avoid delays on
15000 @cindex @code{latexpreview}, STARTUP keyword
15001 @cindex @code{nolatexpreview}, STARTUP keyword
15003 latexpreview @r{preview @LaTeX{} fragments}
15004 nolatexpreview @r{don't preview @LaTeX{} fragments}
15007 @vindex org-log-done
15008 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
15009 @vindex org-log-repeat
15010 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
15011 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
15012 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
15013 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
15014 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
15015 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
15016 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
15017 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
15018 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
15019 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
15020 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
15021 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
15022 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
15023 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
15024 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
15025 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
15026 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
15027 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
15028 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
15029 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
15030 @cindex @code{logdrawer}, STARTUP keyword
15031 @cindex @code{nologdrawer}, STARTUP keyword
15032 @cindex @code{logstatesreversed}, STARTUP keyword
15033 @cindex @code{nologstatesreversed}, STARTUP keyword
15035 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
15036 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
15037 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
15038 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
15039 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
15040 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
15041 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
15042 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
15043 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
15044 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
15045 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
15046 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
15047 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
15048 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
15049 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
15050 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
15051 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
15052 logdrawer @r{store log into drawer}
15053 nologdrawer @r{store log outside of drawer}
15054 logstatesreversed @r{reverse the order of states notes}
15055 nologstatesreversed @r{do not reverse the order of states notes}
15058 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15059 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15060 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
15061 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
15062 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
15063 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
15064 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
15065 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
15066 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
15067 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
15069 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
15070 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
15071 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
15072 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
15073 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
15074 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
15077 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
15078 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
15079 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
15080 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
15081 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
15082 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
15084 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
15087 @vindex constants-unit-system
15088 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
15089 @code{constants-unit-system}).
15090 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
15091 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
15093 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
15094 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
15097 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
15098 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
15099 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
15100 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
15101 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
15102 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
15103 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
15104 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
15105 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
15106 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
15107 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
15108 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
15109 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
15110 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
15111 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
15113 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
15114 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
15115 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
15116 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
15117 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
15118 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
15119 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
15120 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
15121 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
15124 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
15125 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
15126 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
15127 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
15128 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
15130 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
15131 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
15134 @cindex org-pretty-entities
15135 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
15136 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
15137 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
15138 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
15140 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
15141 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
15144 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
15145 @vindex org-tag-alist
15146 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
15147 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
15148 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
15150 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
15151 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
15152 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
15153 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
15154 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
15155 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
15156 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15157 @ref{Export options}.
15158 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15159 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15160 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15161 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15164 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15165 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15167 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15169 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15170 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15171 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15172 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15173 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15174 what this means in different contexts.
15178 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15179 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15181 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15182 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15185 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15186 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15188 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15191 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15192 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15195 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15196 corresponding links in this buffer.
15198 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15199 drawer, offer property commands.
15201 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15202 definition, and vice versa.
15204 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15206 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15209 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15212 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15215 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15218 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15219 @section A cleaner outline view
15220 @cindex hiding leading stars
15221 @cindex dynamic indentation
15222 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15223 @cindex clean outline view
15225 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15226 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15227 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15228 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15229 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15233 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15234 ** Second level | * Second level
15235 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15236 some text | some text
15237 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15238 more text | more text
15239 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15245 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15246 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15247 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15248 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15249 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15250 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15251 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15252 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15253 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15254 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15255 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15256 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15257 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15258 @code{nil}.}; see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15259 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15260 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15261 individual files using
15267 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15268 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15269 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15274 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15275 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15276 with the headline, like
15280 more text, now indented
15283 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15284 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15285 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15286 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15289 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15290 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15291 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15292 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15296 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15297 #+STARTUP: showstars
15300 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15304 * Top level headline
15312 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15313 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15314 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15315 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15316 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15317 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15318 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15321 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15322 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15323 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15324 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15325 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15326 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15327 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15328 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15329 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15336 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15337 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15338 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15339 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15342 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15343 @section Using Org on a tty
15344 @cindex tty key bindings
15346 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15347 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15348 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15349 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15350 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15351 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15352 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15353 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15354 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15355 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15356 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15358 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15359 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15360 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15361 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15362 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15363 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15364 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15365 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15366 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15367 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15368 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15369 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15370 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15371 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15372 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15373 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15374 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15375 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15376 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15377 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15381 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15382 @section Interaction with other packages
15383 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15384 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15385 with other code out there.
15388 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15389 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15392 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15393 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15396 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15397 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15398 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15399 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15400 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15401 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15402 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15403 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15404 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15405 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15406 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15407 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15408 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15409 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15410 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15411 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15412 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15413 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15414 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15415 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15416 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15417 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15418 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15419 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15420 @file{constants.el}.
15421 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15422 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15423 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15424 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15425 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15426 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15427 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15428 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15429 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15431 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15432 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15434 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15435 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15436 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15437 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15438 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15439 @cindex Wiegley, John
15440 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15441 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15442 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15443 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15444 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15445 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15446 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15447 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15448 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15449 @cindex @file{table.el}
15450 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15452 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15453 @cindex @file{table.el}
15454 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15456 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15457 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15458 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15459 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15460 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15461 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15462 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15465 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15466 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15468 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15469 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15470 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15471 format. See the documentation string of the command
15472 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15475 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15476 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15477 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15478 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15479 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15480 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15481 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15484 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15485 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15489 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15490 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15491 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15492 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15493 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15494 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15495 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15496 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15497 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15498 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15499 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15500 cursor moves across a special context.
15502 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15503 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15504 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15505 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15506 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15507 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15508 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15509 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15510 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15511 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15512 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15513 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15514 buffer (but not during date selection).
15517 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15518 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15519 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15522 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15523 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15524 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15525 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15527 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15528 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15530 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15531 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15532 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15536 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15539 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15540 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15541 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15542 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15543 fixed this problem:
15546 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15548 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15549 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15552 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15553 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15557 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15558 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15561 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15564 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15566 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15567 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15568 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15569 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15572 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15573 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15574 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15575 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15576 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15577 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15581 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15582 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15583 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15584 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15585 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15588 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15589 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15591 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15592 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15593 another key for this command, or override the key in
15594 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15597 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15602 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15603 @section org-crypt.el
15604 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15605 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15607 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15608 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15611 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15612 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15613 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15615 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15619 (require 'org-crypt)
15620 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15621 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15623 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15624 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15625 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15627 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15628 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15629 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15630 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15633 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15635 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15638 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15639 being encrypted again.
15641 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15645 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15649 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15650 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15651 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15652 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15653 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15654 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15655 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15656 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15657 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15658 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15661 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15665 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15666 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15667 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15668 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15669 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15671 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15672 @section Add-on packages
15673 @cindex add-on packages
15675 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15676 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15677 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15678 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15679 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15680 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15684 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15685 @section Adding hyperlink types
15686 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15688 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15689 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15690 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15691 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15692 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15696 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15700 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15701 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15703 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15704 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15706 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15708 (defun org-man-open (path)
15709 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15710 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15711 (funcall org-man-command path))
15713 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15714 "Store a link to a manpage."
15715 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15716 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15717 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15718 (link (concat "man:" page))
15719 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15720 (org-store-link-props
15723 :description description))))
15725 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15726 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15727 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15728 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15729 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15730 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15734 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15738 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15745 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15748 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15751 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15752 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15753 that will be called to follow such a link.
15755 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15756 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15757 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15758 buffer displaying a man page.
15761 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15762 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15763 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15764 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15765 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15766 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15767 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15769 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15770 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15771 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15772 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15773 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15774 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15775 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15776 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15777 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15778 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15779 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15780 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15782 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15783 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15784 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15785 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15787 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15788 @section Context-sensitive commands
15789 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15790 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15791 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15793 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15794 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15795 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15797 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15798 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15799 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15800 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15801 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15802 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15803 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15807 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15808 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15809 (if (save-excursion
15810 (beginning-of-line 1)
15811 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15812 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15813 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15814 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15816 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15819 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15820 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15821 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15822 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15823 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15826 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15827 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15828 @cindex tables, in other modes
15829 @cindex lists, in other modes
15830 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15832 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15833 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15834 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15835 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15836 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15839 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15840 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15841 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15842 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15843 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15844 for a very flexible system.
15846 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15847 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15848 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15849 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15853 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15854 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15855 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15856 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15859 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15860 @subsection Radio tables
15861 @cindex radio tables
15863 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15864 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15865 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15866 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15869 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15870 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15874 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15875 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15879 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15883 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15884 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15885 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15886 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15887 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15888 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15889 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15893 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15896 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15897 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15898 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15899 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15900 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15901 additional columns.
15904 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15905 the table. The default value is nil.
15909 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15910 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15911 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15912 number of different solutions:
15916 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15917 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15918 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15920 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15921 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15924 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15925 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15926 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15927 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15931 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15932 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15933 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15935 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15936 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15937 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15938 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15939 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15940 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15941 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15942 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15943 will then get the following template:
15945 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15947 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15948 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15950 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15956 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15957 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15958 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15959 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15960 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15961 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15962 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15963 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15964 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15965 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15966 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15967 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15970 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15971 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15973 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15974 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15975 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15976 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15977 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15978 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15979 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15980 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15985 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15986 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15988 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15989 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15990 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15991 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15992 header and footer commands of the target table:
15995 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15996 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15997 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15998 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
16002 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
16003 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
16004 |-------+------+---------+---------|
16005 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
16006 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
16007 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
16008 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
16012 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
16013 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
16014 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
16015 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
16018 @item :splice nil/t
16019 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
16020 tabular environment. Default is nil.
16023 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
16024 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
16025 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
16026 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
16027 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
16028 function must return a formatted string.
16031 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
16032 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
16033 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
16034 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
16035 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
16036 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
16037 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
16038 supplied instead of strings.
16041 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
16042 @subsection Translator functions
16043 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
16044 @cindex translator function
16046 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
16047 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
16048 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
16049 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
16050 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
16051 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
16052 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
16053 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
16054 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
16058 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
16059 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
16060 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
16061 org-table-last-alignment ""))
16064 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
16065 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
16066 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
16067 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
16068 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
16072 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
16073 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
16074 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
16075 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
16076 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
16077 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
16078 overrule the default with
16081 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
16084 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
16085 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
16086 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
16087 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
16088 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
16089 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
16093 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
16094 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
16098 Please check the documentation string of the function
16099 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
16100 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
16101 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
16102 using the generic function.
16104 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
16105 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
16106 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
16107 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
16108 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
16109 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
16110 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
16111 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
16112 others can benefit from your work.
16114 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
16115 @subsection Radio lists
16116 @cindex radio lists
16117 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
16119 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
16120 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
16121 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
16122 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
16124 Here are the differences with radio tables:
16128 Orgstruct mode must be active.
16130 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
16132 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
16135 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
16138 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
16143 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
16144 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
16146 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
16155 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
16156 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16158 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16159 @section Dynamic blocks
16160 @cindex dynamic blocks
16162 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16163 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16164 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16165 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16167 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16168 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16169 the content of the block.
16171 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16173 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16178 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16181 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16182 Update dynamic block at point.
16183 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16184 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16187 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16188 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16189 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16190 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16191 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16193 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16194 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16195 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16196 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16200 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16206 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16209 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16210 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16211 (insert "Last block update at: "
16212 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16215 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16216 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16217 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16218 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16221 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16222 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16224 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16225 @section Special agenda views
16226 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16228 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16229 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16230 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16231 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16232 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16233 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16234 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16235 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16236 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16237 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16238 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16240 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16241 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16242 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16243 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16244 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16245 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16247 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16248 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16249 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16250 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16251 search should continue from there.
16254 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16255 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16256 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16257 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16258 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16259 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16262 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16266 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16267 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16268 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16269 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16272 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16273 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16274 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16276 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16277 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16278 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16279 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16280 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16281 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16282 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16283 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16284 you really want to have.
16286 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16287 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16288 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16291 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16292 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16293 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16294 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16295 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16296 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16297 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16298 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16299 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16300 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16301 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16302 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16303 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16304 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16305 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16306 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16307 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16308 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16309 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16310 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16311 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16314 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16315 like this, even without defining a special function:
16318 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16319 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16320 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16321 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16322 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16325 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16326 @section Extracting agenda information
16327 @cindex agenda, pipe
16328 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16330 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16331 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16332 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16333 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16334 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16335 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16336 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16337 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16338 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16339 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16340 current TODO list, you could use
16343 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16346 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16347 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16348 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16349 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16352 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16353 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16357 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16360 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16361 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16362 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16363 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16364 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16369 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16370 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16372 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16373 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16374 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16375 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16379 category @r{The category of the item}
16380 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16381 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16382 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16383 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16384 diary @r{imported from diary}
16385 deadline @r{a deadline}
16386 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16387 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16388 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16389 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16390 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16391 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16392 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16393 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16394 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16395 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16396 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16397 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16398 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16402 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16403 led to the selection of the item.
16405 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16406 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16407 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16412 # define the Emacs command to run
16413 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16415 # run it and capture the output
16416 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16418 # loop over all lines
16419 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16420 # get the individual values
16421 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16422 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16423 # process and print
16424 print "[ ] $head\n";
16428 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16429 @section Using the property API
16430 @cindex API, for properties
16431 @cindex properties, API
16433 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16436 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16437 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16438 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16439 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16440 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16441 if the property key was used several times.@*
16442 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16443 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16444 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16446 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16447 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16448 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16449 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16450 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16451 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16452 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16453 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16454 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16457 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16458 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16461 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16462 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16465 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16466 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16469 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16470 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16473 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16474 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16475 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16478 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16479 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16480 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16483 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16484 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16485 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16488 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16489 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16490 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16493 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16494 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16495 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16498 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16499 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16500 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16501 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16502 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16503 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16504 responsible for this property.
16507 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16508 @section Using the mapping API
16509 @cindex API, for mapping
16510 @cindex mapping entries, API
16512 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16513 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16514 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16515 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16518 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16519 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16521 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16522 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16523 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16524 returned as a list.
16526 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16527 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16528 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16529 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16530 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16531 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16532 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16533 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16534 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16537 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16538 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16539 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16540 visited by the iteration.
16542 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16545 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16546 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16547 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16548 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16550 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16551 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16552 agenda-with-archives
16553 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16555 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16558 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16559 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16561 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16563 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16564 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16565 function or Lisp form
16566 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16567 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16568 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16569 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16573 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16574 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16575 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16576 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16578 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16579 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16580 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16583 @defun org-priority &optional action
16584 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16585 possible values for ACTION.
16588 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16589 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16590 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16594 Promote the current entry.
16598 Demote the current entry.
16601 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16602 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16603 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16607 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16608 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16611 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16612 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16615 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16618 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16619 @appendix MobileOrg
16623 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16624 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16625 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16626 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16627 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16628 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16629 Moreland. Android users should check out
16630 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16631 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16634 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16635 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16636 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16638 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16639 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16640 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16641 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16642 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16643 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16644 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16647 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16648 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16649 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16652 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16653 @section Setting up the staging area
16655 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16656 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16657 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16658 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16659 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16660 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16661 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16662 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16663 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16664 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16665 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16667 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16668 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16669 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16670 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16671 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16672 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16673 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16677 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16680 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16681 and to read captured notes from there.
16683 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16684 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16686 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16687 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16688 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16689 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16690 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16691 inside this directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} need to
16692 have the same name than their targets.}.
16694 The push operation also creates a special Org file @file{agendas.org} with
16695 all custom agenda view defined by the user@footnote{While creating the
16696 agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on all referenced entries, so that
16697 these entries can be uniquely identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for
16698 further action. If you do not want to get these properties in so many
16699 entries, you can set the variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}
16700 to @code{nil}. Org mode will then rely on outline paths, in the hope that
16701 these will be unique enough.}.
16703 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16704 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16705 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16706 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16707 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16709 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16710 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16712 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16713 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16714 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16715 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16716 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16720 Org moves all entries found in
16721 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16722 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16723 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16724 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16726 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16727 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16728 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16729 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16730 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16731 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16732 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16733 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16735 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16736 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16737 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16738 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16743 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16744 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16745 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16746 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16747 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16748 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16749 this flagged entry is finished.
16754 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16755 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16756 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16757 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16758 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16759 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16760 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16762 @node History and Acknowledgments, GNU Free Documentation License, MobileOrg, Top
16763 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16764 @cindex acknowledgments
16768 @section From Carsten
16770 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16771 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16772 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16773 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16774 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16775 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16776 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16777 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16778 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16779 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16780 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16781 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16782 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16783 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16784 functionality directly into a notes file.
16786 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16787 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16788 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16789 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16790 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16791 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16792 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16795 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16798 @item Bastien Guerry
16799 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16800 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16801 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16802 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16803 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16804 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16805 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16806 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16807 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16808 programming and reproducible research.
16810 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16811 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16812 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16813 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16814 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16815 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16816 @item Sebastian Rose
16817 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16818 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16819 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16820 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16821 single-key navigation.
16824 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16825 let me know what I am missing here!
16827 @section From Bastien
16829 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16830 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16831 to Carsten's ones above.
16833 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16834 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16835 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16837 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16838 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16839 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16840 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16841 either of the code or the community:
16845 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16846 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16848 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16849 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16850 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16851 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16853 @item Jambunathan K
16854 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16855 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16856 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16857 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16860 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16861 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16862 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16865 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16866 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16867 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16870 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16871 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
16872 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16874 @section List of contributions
16879 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16881 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16883 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16886 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16888 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16890 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16892 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16894 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16895 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16897 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16900 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16901 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16902 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16904 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16906 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16908 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16909 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16912 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16914 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16915 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16916 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16918 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16919 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16921 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16922 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16923 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16925 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16928 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16930 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16932 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16933 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16935 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16937 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16939 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16941 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16944 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16945 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16947 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16949 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16951 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16953 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16956 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16957 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16958 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16960 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16963 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16965 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16966 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16968 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16970 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16972 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16973 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16975 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16976 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16978 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16979 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16980 small fixes and patches.
16982 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16984 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16986 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16989 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16992 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16994 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16995 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16997 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16999 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
17001 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
17002 file links, and TAGS.
17004 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
17005 version of the reference card.
17007 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
17010 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
17012 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
17013 links, among other things.
17015 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
17016 provided frequent feedback.
17018 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
17019 into bundles of 20 for undo.
17021 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
17023 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
17026 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
17027 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
17029 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
17031 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
17032 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
17034 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
17037 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
17038 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
17040 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
17043 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
17045 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
17046 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
17048 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
17049 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
17051 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
17052 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
17054 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
17057 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
17059 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
17060 tweaks and features.
17062 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
17063 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
17065 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
17066 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
17068 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
17069 with links transformation to Org syntax.
17071 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
17072 chapter about publishing.
17074 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
17076 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
17077 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
17079 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
17080 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
17081 concept index for HTML export.
17083 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
17086 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
17088 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
17091 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
17094 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
17097 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
17100 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
17101 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
17105 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Main Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
17106 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
17107 @include doclicense.texi
17110 @node Main Index, Key Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
17111 @unnumbered Concept index
17115 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
17116 @unnumbered Key index
17120 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
17121 @unnumbered Command and function index
17125 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
17126 @unnumbered Variable index
17128 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
17129 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
17130 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
17136 @c Local variables:
17138 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
17139 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
17140 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
17144 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre